blob: 24ba9bd125a2e3a40610fd693d3d57f5d60c2cff [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue54b43a2019-11-25 19:47:40 +01007 2019/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100676. Cache
686.1. Limitation
696.2. Setup
706.2.1. Cache section
716.2.2. Proxy section
72
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200737. Using ACLs and fetching samples
747.1. ACL basics
757.1.1. Matching booleans
767.1.2. Matching integers
777.1.3. Matching strings
787.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
797.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
807.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
827.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200837.3.1. Converters
847.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
857.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
867.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
877.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
887.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100897.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200907.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091
928. Logging
938.1. Log levels
948.2. Log formats
958.2.1. Default log format
968.2.2. TCP log format
978.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100988.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100998.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001008.3. Advanced logging options
1018.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1028.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1038.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1048.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1058.4. Timing events
1068.5. Session state at disconnection
1078.6. Non-printable characters
1088.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1098.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1108.9. Examples of logs
111
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001129. Supported filters
1139.1. Trace
1149.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001159.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001169.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001179.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200118
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011910. FastCGI applications
12010.1. Setup
12110.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12210.1.2. Proxy section
12310.1.3. Example
12410.2. Default parameters
12510.3. Limitations
126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127
1281. Quick reminder about HTTP
129----------------------------
130
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100131When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
133on almost anything found in the contents.
134
135However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
136formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
137correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
138
139
1401.1. The HTTP transaction model
141-------------------------------
142
143The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100144to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100145from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
146connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147will involve a new connection :
148
149 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
150
151In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
152establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
153by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
154length.
155
156Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
157to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
158however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
159response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
160header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
161
162 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
163
164Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
165power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
166but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200167a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100169Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
171second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
172page :
173
174 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
175
176This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
177latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
178correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
179the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100180server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
183time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
184are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
185parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
186carry the stream identifier.
187
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100188By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
189connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
190leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
192processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
193waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200194
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200195HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
197 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100198 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200200 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100202For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
203the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
205is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
206servers.
207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208
2091.2. HTTP request
210-----------------
211
212First, let's consider this HTTP request :
213
214 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
217 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
218 3 User-agent: my small browser
219 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
220 5 Accept: image/png
221
222
2231.2.1. The Request line
224-----------------------
225
226Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
227
228 - a METHOD : GET
229 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
230 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
231
232All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
233which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
234followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
235is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
236desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
237the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
238
239The URI itself can have several forms :
240
241 - A "relative URI" :
242
243 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
244
245 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
246 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
247
248 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
249
250 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
251
252 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
253 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
254 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
255 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
256 must accept this form too.
257
258 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
259 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
260 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200262 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
263 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
264 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
265 other protocols too.
266
267In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
268mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
269on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
270It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
271specific to the language, framework or application in use.
272
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100274assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
276received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
277processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
278as well as in server logs.
279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
296as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
298The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
299that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
300is one valid form of empty line.
301
302Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
303headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
304about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
305application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
306
307Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000308 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
310 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
311 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
312
313
3141.3. HTTP response
315------------------
316
317An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
318messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
319
320 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
323 2 Content-length: 350
324 3 Content-Type: text/html
325
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200326As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
327codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
328response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100329continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
330the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
331following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
332sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
333(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
334correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
335such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
336state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
337over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
338if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
339information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003421.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343------------------------
344
345Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
346
347 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
348 - a status code : 200
349 - a reason : OK
350
351The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100352 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
353 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
354 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
355 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
356 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000358Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100359"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
361messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
362or "Authentication Required".
363
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100364HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200365
366 Code When / reason
367 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
368 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100371 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373 400 for an invalid or too large request
374 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
375 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200376 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100377 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100379 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
380 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
382 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
383 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200384 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
386 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
387 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
388
389The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3904.2).
391
392
3931.3.2. The response headers
394---------------------------
395
396Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
397the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
398details.
399
400
4012. Configuring HAProxy
402----------------------
403
4042.1. Configuration file format
405------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200406
407HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
408
409 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
410 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
411 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
412 "frontend" and "backend".
413
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100414The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
415referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200416delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200418
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004192.2. Quoting and escaping
420-------------------------
421
422HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
423many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
424with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
425single quotes.
426
427If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
428them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
429escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
430
431Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
432
433 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
434 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
435 \\ to use a backslash
436 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
437 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
438
439Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
440the interpretation of:
441
442 space as a parameter separator
443 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
444 # hash as a comment start
445
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200446Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
447-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
448backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
449
450Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200451quoting.
452
453Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
454nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
455
456Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
457equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
458
459 Example:
460 # those are equivalents:
461 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
462 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
463 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
466
467 # those are equivalents:
468 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
469 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
472
473
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004742.3. Environment variables
475--------------------------
476
477HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
478interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
479configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
480optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
481shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
482underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
483
484 Example:
485
486 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
487
488 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
489
490 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
491
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200492Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
493file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200494
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200495* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
496 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
497
498* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
499 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
500 directory.
501
502* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
503
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500504* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200505 processes, separated by semicolons.
506
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500507* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200508 CLI, separated by semicolons.
509
510See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200511
5122.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200513----------------
514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100515Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100516values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
517otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
518numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
519for every keyword. Supported units are :
520
521 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
522 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
523 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
524 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
525 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
526 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
527
528
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005292.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200530-------------
531
532 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
533 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
534 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
535 global
536 daemon
537 maxconn 256
538
539 defaults
540 mode http
541 timeout connect 5000ms
542 timeout client 50000ms
543 timeout server 50000ms
544
545 frontend http-in
546 bind *:80
547 default_backend servers
548
549 backend servers
550 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
551
552
553 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
554 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
555 global
556 daemon
557 maxconn 256
558
559 defaults
560 mode http
561 timeout connect 5000ms
562 timeout client 50000ms
563 timeout server 50000ms
564
565 listen http-in
566 bind *:80
567 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
568
569
570Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
571
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100572 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200573
574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005753. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576--------------------
577
578Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
579are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
580of them have command-line equivalents.
581
582The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
583
584 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200585 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - description
591 - deviceatlas-json-file
592 - deviceatlas-log-level
593 - deviceatlas-separator
594 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900595 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596 - gid
597 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100598 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200599 - h1-case-adjust
600 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100601 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100602 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200603 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100605 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200607 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200609 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200610 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - presetenv
613 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - uid
615 - ulimit-n
616 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200617 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200619 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200620 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-options
623 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-options
626 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100627 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100628 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100629 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100630 - 51degrees-data-file
631 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200632 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200633 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200634 - wurfl-data-file
635 - wurfl-information-list
636 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200637 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100638 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100639
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200640 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100641 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200642 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200644 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100645 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100646 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100647 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200648 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200649 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200650 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200651 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200652 - noepoll
653 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000654 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200655 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100656 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300657 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000658 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100659 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200660 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200661 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200662 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000663 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000664 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200665 - tune.buffers.limit
666 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200667 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200668 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100669 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200670 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200671 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200672 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100673 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200674 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200675 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100676 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100677 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100678 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100679 - tune.lua.session-timeout
680 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200681 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100682 - tune.maxaccept
683 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200684 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200685 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200686 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100687 - tune.rcvbuf.client
688 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100689 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200690 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100691 - tune.sndbuf.client
692 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100693 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100694 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200695 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100696 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200697 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200698 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100699 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200700 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100701 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200702 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
703 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
704 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100705 - tune.zlib.memlevel
706 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100707
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200708 * Debugging
709 - debug
710 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711
712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007133.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714------------------------------------
715
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200716ca-base <dir>
717 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200718 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
719 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200720
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721chroot <jail dir>
722 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
723 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
724 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
725 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
726 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100727 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100728
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
730 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
731 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
732 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
733 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
734 set. These sets have the format
735
736 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
737
738 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100739 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
741 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100742 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
743 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100744 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100745 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100746 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
749 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
750 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
751 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100752
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100753 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
754 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
755 on the machine's word size.
756
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100757 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
759 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
760 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
761 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
762 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
763 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100764
765 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100766 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
767
768 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
769 # first 4 CPUs
770
771 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
772 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
773 # word size.
774
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100775 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100776 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100777 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
778 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
779 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
780
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100781 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
782 # and so on.
783 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
784 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
785 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
786
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100787 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100788 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
789 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
790 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
791
792 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
793 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
794 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
795
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100796 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
797 # and a thread range.
798 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
799 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
800 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
801
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200802crt-base <dir>
803 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100804 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
805 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200806
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807daemon
808 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
809 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100810 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
811 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200812
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200813deviceatlas-json-file <path>
814 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100815 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200816
817deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100818 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200819 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
820
821deviceatlas-separator <char>
822 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
823 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
824
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100825deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200826 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
827 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
828 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100829
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900830external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100831 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
832 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
834 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
835 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
836 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
837 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900838
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200839gid <number>
840 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
841 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
842 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100843 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
844 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100846
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100847group <group name>
848 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
849 See also "gid" and "user".
850
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100851hard-stop-after <time>
852 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
853
854 Arguments :
855 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
856 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
857 SIGUSR1 signal.
858
859 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
860 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
861 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
862
863 Example:
864 global
865 hard-stop-after 30s
866
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200867h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
868 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
869 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
870 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
871 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
872 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
873 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
874 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
875 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
876 specified in a proxy.
877
878 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
879 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
880 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
881 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
882 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
883 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
884 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
885
886 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
887 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
888 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
889 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
890 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
891
892 Example:
893 global
894 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
895
896 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
897 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
898
899h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
900 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
901 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
902 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
903 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
904 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
905 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
906 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
907 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
908
909 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
910 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
911 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
912
913 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
914 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
915
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100916insecure-fork-wanted
917 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
918 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
919 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
920 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
921 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
922 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
923 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
924 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
925 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
926 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
927 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
928 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
929 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
930 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
931 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
932 disable it.
933
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100934insecure-setuid-wanted
935 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
936 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
937 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
938 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
939 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
940 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
941 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
942 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
943 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
944 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
945 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
946 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
947 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
948 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
949
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200950log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
951 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100952 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100953 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100954 configured with "log global".
955
956 <address> can be one of:
957
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100958 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100959 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
960 port).
961
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100962 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
963 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
964 port).
965
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100966 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100967 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
968 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100969 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100970
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100971 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
972 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
973 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
974 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
975 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
976 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
977 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
978 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
979 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
980 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
981 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
982 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
983 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
984 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100985 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
986 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100987
988 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
989 "fd@2", see above.
990
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200991 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
992 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
993 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
994 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
995 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
996
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200997 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
998 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100999
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001000 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1001 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1002 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1003 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1004 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1005 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1006 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1007 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1008 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1009 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001010 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1011 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001012
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001013 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1014 one of the following :
1015
1016 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1017 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1018
1019 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1020 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1021
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001022 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1023 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1024 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1025 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1026 logger consumes.
1027
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001028 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1029 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1030 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1031 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1032
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001033 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1034 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1035 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1036 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1037 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1038
1039 <sample_size>
1040 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1041 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1042 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1043 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1044 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1045
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001046 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001047
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001048 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1049 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1050 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1051
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001052 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1053 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1054 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1055 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
1057 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001058 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1059 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1060 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1061 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1062 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1063 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001065 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001067log-send-hostname [<string>]
1068 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1069 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1070 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1071 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1072 the logs.
1073
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001074log-tag <string>
1075 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1076 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1077 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001078 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001079
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001080lua-load <file>
1081 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1082 used multiple times.
1083
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001084master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001085 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1086 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1087 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001088 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001089 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1090 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001091 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1092 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1093 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1094 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1095 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001096
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001097 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001098
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001099mworker-max-reloads <number>
1100 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001101 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001102 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1103 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1104 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1105
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001106nbproc <number>
1107 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1108 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1109 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001110 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1111 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001112 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1113 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001114
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001115nbthread <number>
1116 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001117 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1118 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1119 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1120 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1121 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001122 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1123 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1124 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1125 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1126 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1127 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1128 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001129
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001130pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001131 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001132 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1133 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1134
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001135presetenv <name> <value>
1136 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1137 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1138 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1139 and "unsetenv".
1140
1141resetenv [<name> ...]
1142 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1143 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1144 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1145 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1146 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1147 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1148 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1149 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1150
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001151stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001152 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1153 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1154 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1155 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1156 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1157 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001158 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001159 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1160 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1161 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1162 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001163
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001164server-state-base <directory>
1165 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001166 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1167 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001168
1169server-state-file <file>
1170 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1171 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1172 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1173 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1174 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1175 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1176 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1177 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001178 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1179 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001180
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001181setenv <name> <value>
1182 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1183 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1184 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1185 and "unsetenv".
1186
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001187set-dumpable
1188 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001189 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1190 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1191 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1192 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1193 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1194 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1195 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1196 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1197 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1198 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1199 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1200 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1201 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1202 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1203 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1204 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1205 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001206
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001207ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1209 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001210 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001211 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001212 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1213 information and recommendations see e.g.
1214 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1215 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1216 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1217 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001218
1219ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1221 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1222 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1223 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1224 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001225 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1226 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1227 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001228 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001229
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001230ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1232 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1233 keyword to see available options.
1234
1235 Example:
1236 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001237 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001238
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001239ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1240 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1241 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001242 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001243 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001244 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1245 information and recommendations see e.g.
1246 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1247 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1248 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1249 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1250 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001251
1252ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1254 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1255 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1256 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1257 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001258 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1259 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1260 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1261 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001262
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001263ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1265 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1266 keyword to see available options.
1267
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001268ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1269 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1270 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1271 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001272 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001273 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001274 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1275 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1276 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1277 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001278 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1279 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1280 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1281
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001282ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1283 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1284 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1285 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1286
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001287stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1288 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1289 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1290 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001291 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001292 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001293
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001294 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1295 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1296 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001297
1298stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1299 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1300 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001301 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001302
1303stats maxconn <connections>
1304 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1305 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1306
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001307uid <number>
1308 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1309 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1310 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1311 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1312
1313ulimit-n <number>
1314 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1315 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1316 option.
1317
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001318unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1319 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1320
1321 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1322 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1323 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1324 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1325 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1326 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1327 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1328 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1329 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1330 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1331
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001332unsetenv [<name> ...]
1333 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1334 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1335 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1336 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1337 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1338 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1339 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1340
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001341user <user name>
1342 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1343 See also "uid" and "group".
1344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001345node <name>
1346 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1347
1348 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1349 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1350 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1351 traffic.
1352
1353description <text>
1354 Add a text that describes the instance.
1355
1356 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1357 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1358 "<" and ">" characters.
1359
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100136051degrees-data-file <file path>
1361 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001362 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001363
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001364 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001365 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1366
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000136751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001368 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1369 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1370 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1371
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001372 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001373 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1374
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200137551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001376 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1377 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1378
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001379 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1380 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1381
138251degrees-cache-size <number>
1383 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1384 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1385 By default, this cache is disabled.
1386
1387 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001388 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1389
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001390wurfl-data-file <file path>
1391 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1392 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1393
1394 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1395 with USE_WURFL=1.
1396
1397wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1398 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1399 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1400 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1401
1402 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1403
1404 Valid WURFL properties are:
1405 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1406
1407 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1408 device.
1409
1410 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1411 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1412
1413 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1414 particular web request.
1415
1416 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1417 used Libwurfl API version.
1418
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001419 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1420 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1421
1422 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1423 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1424
1425 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1426
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001427 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1428 with USE_WURFL=1.
1429
1430wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1431 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1432 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1433
1434 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1435 with USE_WURFL=1.
1436
1437wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1438 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1439 thus before the chroot.
1440
1441 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1442 with USE_WURFL=1.
1443
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001444wurfl-cache-size <size>
1445 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1446 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001447 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001448 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001449
1450 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1451 with USE_WURFL=1.
1452
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001453strict-limits
1454 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1455 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1456 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1457 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1458 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1459 keyword.
1460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014613.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001462-----------------------
1463
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001464busy-polling
1465 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1466 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1467 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1468 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1469 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1470 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1471 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1472 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1473 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1474 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1475 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1476 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1477 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1478 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1479 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1480 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1481 "poll" pollers.
1482
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001483 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1484 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1485 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1486
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001487max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1488 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1489 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1490 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1491 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1492 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1493 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1494 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1495 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1496
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001497maxconn <number>
1498 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1499 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1500 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001501 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1502 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1503 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1504 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001505 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1506 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1507 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1508 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1509 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1510 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001511
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001512maxconnrate <number>
1513 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1514 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1515 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1516 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1517 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1518 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1519 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1520 fairness.
1521
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001522maxcomprate <number>
1523 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001524 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001525 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1526 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1527 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001528 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001529 default value.
1530
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001531maxcompcpuusage <number>
1532 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1533 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1534 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1535 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1536 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1537 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1538 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1539 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1540
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001541maxpipes <number>
1542 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1543 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1544 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1545 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1546 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1547 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1548
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001549maxsessrate <number>
1550 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1551 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1552 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1553 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1554 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1555 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1556 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1557 fairness.
1558
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001559maxsslconn <number>
1560 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1561 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1562 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1563 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1564 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1565 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1566 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001567 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1568 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1569 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1570 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1571 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1572 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1573 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001574
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001575maxsslrate <number>
1576 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1577 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1578 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1579 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1580 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1581 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1582 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1583 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1584 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1585 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1586
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001587maxzlibmem <number>
1588 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1589 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1590 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001591 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1592 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1593 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1594
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001595noepoll
1596 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1597 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001598 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001599
1600nokqueue
1601 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1602 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1603 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1604
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001605noevports
1606 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1607 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1608 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1609 also "nopoll".
1610
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001611nopoll
1612 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1613 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001614 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001615 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1616 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001617
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001618nosplice
1619 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001620 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001621 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001622 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001623 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1624 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1625 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1626 "option splice-response".
1627
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001628nogetaddrinfo
1629 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1630 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1631
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001632noreuseport
1633 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1634 command line argument "-dR".
1635
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001636profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1637 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1638 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1639 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1640 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001641 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001642 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1643 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1644 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1645 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1646
1647 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1648 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1649 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1650 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1651 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001652 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1653 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1654 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1655 CLI.
1656
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001657spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001658 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1659 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1660 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1661 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1662 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1663 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001664
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001665ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001666 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001667 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001668 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1669 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1670 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1671 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1672 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001673 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1674 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001675 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1676 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1677 openssl configuration file uses:
1678 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1679
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001680ssl-mode-async
1681 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001682 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001683 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1684 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1685 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001686 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001687 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001688
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001689tune.buffers.limit <number>
1690 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1691 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1692 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1693 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1694 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001695 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001696 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1697 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1698 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1699 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1700 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1701 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1702 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1703 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1704 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1705
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001706tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1707 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1708 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1709 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1710 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1711
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001712tune.bufsize <number>
1713 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1714 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1715 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1716 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1717 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1718 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1719 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001720 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1721 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1722 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001723 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001724 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1725 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1726 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001727
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001728tune.chksize <number>
1729 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1730 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1731 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1732 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1733 checks whenever possible.
1734
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001735tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1736 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1737 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1738 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1739 this value. The default value is 1.
1740
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001741tune.fail-alloc
1742 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1743 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1744 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1745 gracefully.
1746
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001747tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1748 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1749 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1750 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1751 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1752 change it.
1753
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001754tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1755 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001756 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1757 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001758 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1759 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1760 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1761 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1762 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1763
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001764tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1765 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1766 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1767 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1768 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1769 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1770 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1771 recommended not to change this value.
1772
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001773tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1774 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1775 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1776 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1777 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1778 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1779 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1780 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1781
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001782tune.http.cookielen <number>
1783 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1784 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1785 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1786 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1787 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1788 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1789 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1790 to change this value.
1791
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001792tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001793 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1794 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001795 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001796 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001797 configuration directives too.
1798 The default value is 1024.
1799
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001800tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1801 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1802 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1803 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1804 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1805 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1806 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001807 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1808 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1809 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001810
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001811tune.idletimer <timeout>
1812 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1813 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1814 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1815 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1816 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1817 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001818 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001819 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001820 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1821
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001822tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1823 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1824 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1825 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1826 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1827 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1828 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1829 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1830 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1831 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1832
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001833tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1834 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001835 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001836 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1837 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001838 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001839 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1840 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1841
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001842tune.lua.maxmem
1843 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1844 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1845 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1846 memory.
1847
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001848tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1849 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001850 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1851 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001852 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001853
1854tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1855 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1856 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1857 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1858 check servers.
1859
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001860tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1861 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1862 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1863 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001864 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001865
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001866tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001867 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1868 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1869 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1870 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1871 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1872 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1873 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1874 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1875 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1876 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001877
1878tune.maxpollevents <number>
1879 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1880 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1881 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1882 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1883 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1884
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001885tune.maxrewrite <number>
1886 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1887 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1888 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1889 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1890 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1891 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1892 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1893 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1894 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1895 bufsize.
1896
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001897tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1898 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1899 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1900 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1901 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1902 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1903 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1904 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1905 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1906 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001907 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1908 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001909 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1910 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1911 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1912 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1913 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1914 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1915 setting this parameter to 0.
1916
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001917tune.pipesize <number>
1918 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1919 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1920 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1921 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1922 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1923 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1924
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001925tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1926 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1927 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1928 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1929 default is 20.
1930
1931tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1932 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1933 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1934 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1935 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1936 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1937 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001938 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001939
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001940tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1941tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1942 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1943 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1944 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001945 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001947 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1948 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1949
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001950tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001951 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001952 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1953 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1954 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1955 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1956
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001957tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001958 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001959 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1960 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1961
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001962tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1963tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1964 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1965 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1966 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001967 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001968 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001969 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1970 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1971 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1972 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1973 notifying haproxy again.
1974
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001975tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001976 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1977 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1978 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001979 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001980 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001981 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001982 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1983 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1984 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001985 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1986 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001987
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001988tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001989 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001990 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1991 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1992 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1993 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1994 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1995
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001996tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1997 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001998 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001999 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2000 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2001 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2002 being used for too long.
2003
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002004tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2005 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2006 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2007 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2008 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2009 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2010 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2011 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2012 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2013 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2014 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002015 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002016 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002017
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002018tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2019 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2020 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2021 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2022 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2023 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2024 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2025 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002026 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2027 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002028
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002029tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2030 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2031 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2032 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2033 1000 entries.
2034
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002035tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2036 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2037 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2038 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2039
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002040tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002041tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002042tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2043tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2044tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002045 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2046 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2047 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2048 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2049 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2050 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2051 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2052 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002053
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002054 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2055 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2056 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2057 all available space is consumed.
2058 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2059 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2060 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002061
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002062tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2063 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002064 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002065 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002066 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002067 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2068
2069tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2070 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2071 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002072 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2073 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020753.3. Debugging
2076--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002077
2078debug
2079 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2080 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2081 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2082 system startup.
2083
2084quiet
2085 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2086 line argument "-q".
2087
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020893.4. Userlists
2090--------------
2091It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2092http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2093it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2094
2095userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002096 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002097 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2098
2099group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002100 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002101 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2102 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2103
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002104user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2105 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002106 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2107 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002108 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2109 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2110 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2111 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002112
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002113 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2114 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2115 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2116 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2117 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2118 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2119 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2120 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2121 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002122
2123 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002124 userlist L1
2125 group G1 users tiger,scott
2126 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002128 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2129 user scott insecure-password elgato
2130 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002131
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002132 userlist L2
2133 group G1
2134 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002135
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002136 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2137 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2138 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002139
2140 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002141
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002142
21433.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002144----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002145It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2146several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2147instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2148values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2149automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2150In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2151using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2152tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2153reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2154Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2155that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2156each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002157
2158peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002159 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002160 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2161
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002162bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2163 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2164 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2165
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002166disabled
2167 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2168 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2169 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2170
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002171default-bind [param*]
2172 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2173
2174default-server [param*]
2175 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2176
2177 Arguments:
2178 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2179 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2180 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2181 details.
2182
2183
2184 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2185
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002186enable
2187 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2188
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002189log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2190 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2191 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2192 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2193 more details.
2194
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002195peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002196 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2197 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2198 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2199 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2200 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2201 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2202
2203 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2204 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2205
2206 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2207 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2208 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2209 across all peers.
2210
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002211 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2212 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002213
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002214 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2215 "server" keyword explanation below).
2216
2217server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002218 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002219 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2220 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2221 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2222 of this "peers" section).
2223 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2224
2225
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002226 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002227 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002228 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002229 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2230 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2231 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002232
2233 backend mybackend
2234 mode tcp
2235 balance roundrobin
2236 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2237 stick on src
2238
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002239 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2240 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002241
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002242 Example:
2243 peers mypeers
2244 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2245 default-server ssl verify none
2246 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2247 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002248
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002249
2250table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2251 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2252
2253 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2254 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002255 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002256 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2257 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2258 "stick-table" keyword).
2259
2260 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2261 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2262 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2263 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2264 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2265 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2266 of the stick-table name as follows:
2267
2268 peers mypeers
2269 peer A ...
2270 peer B ...
2271 table t1 ...
2272
2273 frontend fe1
2274 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2275
2276 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2277 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2278
2279 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2280 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2281 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2282 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2283 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2284 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2285 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2286
2287 peers mypeers
2288 peer A ...
2289 peer B ...
2290 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2291
2292 backend t1
2293 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2294
2295 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2296 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2297 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2298
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022993.6. Mailers
2300------------
2301It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2302If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2303in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2304
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002305mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002306 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2307 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2308
2309mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2310 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2311
2312 Example:
2313 mailers mymailers
2314 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2315 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2316
2317 backend mybackend
2318 mode tcp
2319 balance roundrobin
2320
2321 email-alert mailers mymailers
2322 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2323 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2324
2325 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2326 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2327
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002328timeout mail <time>
2329 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2330 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2331 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2332 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2333
2334 Example:
2335 mailers mymailers
2336 timeout mail 20s
2337 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002338
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020023393.7. Programs
2340-------------
2341In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2342master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2343managed the same way as the workers.
2344
2345During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2346sequence as a worker:
2347
2348 - the master is re-executed
2349 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2350 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2351 instance of the program
2352
2353During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2354
2355program <name>
2356 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2357 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2358 the management guide).
2359
2360command <command> [arguments*]
2361 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2362 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2363 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2364 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2365
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002366user <user name>
2367 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2368 See also "group".
2369
2370group <group name>
2371 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2372 See also "user".
2373
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002374option start-on-reload
2375no option start-on-reload
2376 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2377 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2378 program section.
2379
2380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023814. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002382----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002384Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002385 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002386 - frontend <name>
2387 - backend <name>
2388 - listen <name>
2389
2390A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2391its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2392section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002393section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002394
2395A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2396connections.
2397
2398A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2399to forward incoming connections.
2400
2401A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2402parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2405'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2406case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2407
2408Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2409logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2410proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2411However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2412name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2413
2414Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2415and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002416bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2418modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2419arbitrary criteria.
2420
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002421In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2422a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002423the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002424
2425 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2426 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2427 between responses and new requests.
2428
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002429 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2430 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2431 client-facing connection remains open.
2432
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002433 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2434 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002435
2436The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2437frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2438following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002439weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002440
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002441 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002442
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002443 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2444 ----+-----+-----+----
2445 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2446 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002447 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2448 ----+-----+-----+----
2449 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002450
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002451
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2454--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002456The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2457limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2458they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2459limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002460marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002461option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002462and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2463with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2464specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002466
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002467 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2468------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2469acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470backlog X X X -
2471balance X - X X
2472bind - X X -
2473bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002474capture cookie - X X -
2475capture request header - X X -
2476capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002477compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002478cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002479declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002480default-server X - X X
2481default_backend X X X -
2482description - X X X
2483disabled X X X X
2484dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002485email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002486email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002487email-alert mailers X X X X
2488email-alert myhostname X X X X
2489email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002490enabled X X X X
2491errorfile X X X X
2492errorloc X X X X
2493errorloc302 X X X X
2494-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2495errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002496force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002497filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002498fullconn X - X X
2499grace X X X X
2500hash-type X - X X
2501http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002502http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002503http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002504http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002505http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002506http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002507http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002509ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002510load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002511log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002512log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002513log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002514log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002515max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002516maxconn X X X -
2517mode X X X X
2518monitor fail - X X -
2519monitor-net X X X -
2520monitor-uri X X X -
2521option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2522option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2523option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2524option allbackups (*) X - X X
2525option checkcache (*) X - X X
2526option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2527option contstats (*) X X X -
2528option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2529option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002530-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2531option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002532option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2533option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002534option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002535option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002536option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002537option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002538option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2540option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2541option httpchk X - X X
2542option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002543option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002544option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002545option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002546option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002547option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002548option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2549option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2550option logasap (*) X X X -
2551option mysql-check X - X X
2552option nolinger (*) X X X X
2553option originalto X X X X
2554option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002555option pgsql-check X - X X
2556option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002557option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002558option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002559option smtpchk X - X X
2560option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2561option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2562option splice-request (*) X X X X
2563option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002564option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002565option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2566option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2567-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002568option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002569option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2570option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2571option tcpka X X X X
2572option tcplog X X X X
2573option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002574external-check command X - X X
2575external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002576persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2577rate-limit sessions X X X -
2578redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002579-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002581retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002582server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002583server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002584server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002585source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002586stats admin - X X X
2587stats auth X X X X
2588stats enable X X X X
2589stats hide-version X X X X
2590stats http-request - X X X
2591stats realm X X X X
2592stats refresh X X X X
2593stats scope X X X X
2594stats show-desc X X X X
2595stats show-legends X X X X
2596stats show-node X X X X
2597stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002598-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2599stick match - - X X
2600stick on - - X X
2601stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002602stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002603stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002604tcp-check connect - - X X
2605tcp-check expect - - X X
2606tcp-check send - - X X
2607tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002608tcp-request connection - X X -
2609tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002610tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002611tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002612tcp-response content - - X X
2613tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002614timeout check X - X X
2615timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002616timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002617timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002618timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2619timeout http-request X X X X
2620timeout queue X - X X
2621timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002622timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002624timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002625transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002626unique-id-format X X X -
2627unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002628use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002629use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002630use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002631------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2632 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026354.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2636---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637
2638This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2639
2640
2641acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2642 Declare or complete an access list.
2643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2644 no | yes | yes | yes
2645 Example:
2646 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2647 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2648 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002650 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002651
2652
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002653backlog <conns>
2654 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2656 yes | yes | yes | no
2657 Arguments :
2658 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2659 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002660 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002661
2662 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2663 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2664 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2665 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2666 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2667 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2668 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2669 backlog parameter.
2670
2671 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2672 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2673 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2674
2675 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2676
2677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002679balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2682 yes | no | yes | yes
2683 Arguments :
2684 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2685 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2686 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2687 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2688
2689 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2690 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2691 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2692 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002693 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002694 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002695 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2696 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2697 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2698 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2699 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2700 it, so that you don't worry.
2701
2702 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2703 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2704 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2705 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2706 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2707 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2708 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2709 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002710
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002711 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2712 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2713 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2714 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2715 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2716 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2717 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2718 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2719
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002720 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002721 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002722 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2723 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002724 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002725 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2726 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2727 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2728 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2729 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002730 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2731 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2732 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2733 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2734 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2735 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2738 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2739 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2740 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2741 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2742 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2743 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2744 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002745 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002747 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2748 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2749 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002750
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002751 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2752 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2753 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2754 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2755 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2756 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2757 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2758 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2759 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2760 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2761 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2762 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002764 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002765 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2766 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2767 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2768 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2769 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2770 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2771 URIs start with a leading "/".
2772
2773 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2774 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2775 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2776 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002779 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2780
2781 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002782 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2783 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002784 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2785 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2786 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2787 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002788 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002789 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2790 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002791
2792 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2793 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2794 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2795 server will receive the request.
2796
2797 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2798 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2799 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2800 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2801 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002802 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2803 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2804 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002805
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002806 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2807 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2808 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2809 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2810 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002812 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002813 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2814 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2815 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2816
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002817 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2818 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2819 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2820
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002821 random
2822 random(<draws>)
2823 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002824 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2825 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2826 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2827 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002828 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2829 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2830 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2831 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2832 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2833 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2834 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2835 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2836 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2837 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2838 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2839 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2840 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2841 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2842 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2843 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2844 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2845 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2846 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2847 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002848
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002849 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002850 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002851 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2852 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2853 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2854 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2855 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2856 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002857 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002858 used instead.
2859
2860 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2861 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2862 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2863 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2864
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002865 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2866 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2867 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2868
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002869 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002870
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002871 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002872 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2873 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002874
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002875 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2876 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2877 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002879 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002880 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002881 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2882 NTLM relies on.
2883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002884 Examples :
2885 balance roundrobin
2886 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002887 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002888 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2889 balance hdr(host)
2890 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002891
2892 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2893 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002895 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002896 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2897 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2898 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002899 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002900
2901 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2902 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2903 defaults to 16 kB.
2904
2905 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2906 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2907
2908 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2909 Round Robin.
2910
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002911 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002912 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2913 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2914 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2915
2916 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2917
2918 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002919 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002920 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2921 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2922 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002923
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002924 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925
2926
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002927bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2928bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002929 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2931 no | yes | yes | no
2932 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002933 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2934 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2935 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2936 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002937 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002938 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2939 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2940 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2941 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2942 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2943 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2944 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002945 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2946 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2947 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2948 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2949 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2950 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2951 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002952 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2953 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2954 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002955 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2956 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2957 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2958 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002959 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2960 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2961 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002962
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002963 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2964 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002965 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2966 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2967 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002968 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2969 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2970 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2971 the range.
2972
2973 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2974 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2975 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2976 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2977 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2978 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2979 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002980 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002981 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002982
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002983 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002984 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002985 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2986 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2987 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2988 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2989 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2990 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2991
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002992 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2993 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2994 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2995 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2998 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2999 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3000 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3001 in a frontend.
3002
3003 Example :
3004 listen http_proxy
3005 bind :80,:443
3006 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003007 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003008
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003009 listen http_https_proxy
3010 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003011 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003012
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003013 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3014 bind ipv6@:80
3015 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3016 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3017
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003018 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003019 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003020
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003021 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3022 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3023 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3024 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3025 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3026
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003027 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003028 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003029
3030
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003031bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003032 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3034 yes | yes | yes | yes
3035 Arguments :
3036 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3037 may be used to override a default value.
3038
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003039 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003040 option may be combined with other numbers.
3041
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003042 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003043 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3044 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3045 missing from all processes.
3046
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003047 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003048 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003049 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3050 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3051 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3052 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3053 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003054 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003055
3056 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3057 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3058 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3059 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3060 and 'even' instances.
3061
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003062 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3063 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3064 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3065 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003066
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003067 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3068 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3069
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003070 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3071 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3072 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3073
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003074 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3075 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3076
3077 Example :
3078 listen app_ip1
3079 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003080 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003081
3082 listen app_ip2
3083 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003084 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003085
3086 listen management
3087 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003088 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003089
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003090 listen management
3091 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3092 bind-process 1-4
3093
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003094 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003095
3096
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003097capture cookie <name> len <length>
3098 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3100 no | yes | yes | no
3101 Arguments :
3102 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3103 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3104 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3105 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003106 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003107
3108 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3109 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3110 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3111 right if it exceeds <length>.
3112
3113 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3114 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3115 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3116 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3117
3118 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3119 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3120 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3121
3122 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3123 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3124 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003125 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3126 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3127 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128
3129 Example:
3130 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3131
3132 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003133 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003134
3135
3136capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003137 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3139 no | yes | yes | no
3140 Arguments :
3141 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003142 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3144 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3145 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3146
3147 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3148 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3149 it exceeds <length>.
3150
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003151 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003152 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3153 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003154 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3155 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3156 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3157 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003158 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003159 environments to find where the request came from.
3160
3161 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3162 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3163 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3164 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003165
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003166 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3167 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3168 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3169 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3170 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171
3172 Example:
3173 capture request header Host len 15
3174 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003175 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003177 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003178 about logging.
3179
3180
3181capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003182 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3184 no | yes | yes | no
3185 Arguments :
3186 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003187 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003188 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3189 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3190 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3191
3192 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3193 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3194 it exceeds <length>.
3195
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003196 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003197 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3198 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3199 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003200 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3201 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3202 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3203 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003204
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003205 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3206 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3207 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3208 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3209 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003210
3211 Example:
3212 capture response header Content-length len 9
3213 capture response header Location len 15
3214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003215 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003216 about logging.
3217
3218
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003219compression algo <algorithm> ...
3220compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003221compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003222 Enable HTTP compression.
3223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3224 yes | yes | yes | yes
3225 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003226 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3227 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3228 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3229
3230 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003231 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3232 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3233 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003234
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003235 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003236 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003237
3238 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3239 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3240 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3241 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3242 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003243 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003244
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003245 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3246 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3247 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3248 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3249 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3250 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3251 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003252 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003253
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003254 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003255 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003256 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3257 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3258 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3259 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3260 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003261
3262 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3263 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3264 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3265 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3266 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003267 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3268 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3269 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3270 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3271 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003272 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3273 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003274
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003275 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003276 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3277 "Accept-Encoding" header
3278 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003279 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003280 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3281 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3282 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3283 "multipart"
3284 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3285 header
3286 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3287 and later
3288 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3289 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003290 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003291
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003292 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003293
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003294 Examples :
3295 compression algo gzip
3296 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003297
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003298
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003299cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003300 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3301 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003302 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003303 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3305 yes | no | yes | yes
3306 Arguments :
3307 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3308 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3309 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3310 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3311 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3312 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003313 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003314 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3315 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3316
3317 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3318 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3319 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3320 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3321 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3322 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003323 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3324 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003325 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003326 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3327 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003328
3329 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003330 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003331
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003332 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003333 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003334 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003335 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003336 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3337 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3338 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3339 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3340 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3341 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3342 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003343
3344 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3345 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3346 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3347 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3348 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3349 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3350 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3351 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3352 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003353 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003354 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3355 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3356 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003357
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003358 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3359 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3360 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003361 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3362 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3363 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3364 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003365 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3366 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3367 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368
3369 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3370 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3371 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3372 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3373 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3374 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3375 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3376 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3377 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3378
3379 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3380 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3381 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3382 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3383 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3384 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3385 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3386 persistence cookie in the cache.
3387 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3388
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003389 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3390 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3391 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3392 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3393 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003394 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003395 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3396 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3397 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3398 they logout.
3399
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003400 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3401 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3402 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3403 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3404
3405 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3406 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3407 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3408 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3409 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3410 this attribute.
3411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003412 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003413 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003414 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3415 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3416 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3417 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3418 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3419 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003420
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003421 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3422 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3423 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3424 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3425 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3426 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3427 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3428 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003429 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003430 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3431 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3432 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3433 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3434 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3435 the site.
3436
3437 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3438 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3439 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3440 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3441 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3442 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3443 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3444 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3445 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3446 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3447 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3448 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3449 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003450 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003451 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3452 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3453
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003454 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3455 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3456 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3457 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3458 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3459 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3460
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3462 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3463 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3464 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003465
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466 Examples :
3467 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3468 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3469 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003470 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003471
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003472 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003473
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003474
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003475declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3476 Declares a capture slot.
3477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3478 no | yes | yes | no
3479 Arguments:
3480 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3481
3482 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3483 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3484 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3485 for use in the response.
3486
3487 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003488 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003489 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3490
3491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003492default-server [param*]
3493 Change default options for a server in a backend
3494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3495 yes | no | yes | yes
3496 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003497 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3498 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3499 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3500 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003501
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003502 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003503 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3504
3505 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003506
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003507
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003508default_backend <backend>
3509 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3511 yes | yes | yes | no
3512 Arguments :
3513 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3514
3515 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3516 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3517 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3518 will catch all undetermined requests.
3519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520 Example :
3521
3522 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3523 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3524 default_backend dynamic
3525
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003526 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003527
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003529description <string>
3530 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3532 no | yes | yes | yes
3533 Arguments : string
3534
3535 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3536 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3537 it describes.
3538 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3539
3540
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003541disabled
3542 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3544 yes | yes | yes | yes
3545 Arguments : none
3546
3547 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3548 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3549 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3550 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3551 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3552 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3553 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3554
3555 See also : "enabled"
3556
3557
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003558dispatch <address>:<port>
3559 Set a default server address
3560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3561 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003562 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003563
3564 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3565 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3566 during start-up.
3567
3568 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3569 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3570 possible with normal servers.
3571
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003572 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003573 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3574 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3575 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3576 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3577
3578 See also : "server"
3579
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003580
3581dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3582 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3584 yes | no | yes | yes
3585 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3586
3587 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003588 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003589 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3590 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003591 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003592 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003593
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003594enabled
3595 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3597 yes | yes | yes | yes
3598 Arguments : none
3599
3600 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3601 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3602
3603 See also : "disabled"
3604
3605
3606errorfile <code> <file>
3607 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3609 yes | yes | yes | yes
3610 Arguments :
3611 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003612 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3613 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003614
3615 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003616 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003617 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003618 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3619 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620
3621 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3622 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3623 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3624
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003625 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003627 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3628 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3629 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3630 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3631
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003632 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3633 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003634 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003635 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3636 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3637 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3638
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3640 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3641 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003642 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003643 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3644
3645 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3646
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003647 Example :
3648 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003649 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003650 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3651 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3652
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003653
3654errorloc <code> <url>
3655errorloc302 <code> <url>
3656 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3658 yes | yes | yes | yes
3659 Arguments :
3660 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003661 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3662 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003663
3664 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3665 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3666 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3667 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003668 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003669
3670 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3671 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3672 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3673
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003674 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3675
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003676 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3677 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3678 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3679 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003680 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003681 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3682 request.
3683
3684 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3685
3686
3687errorloc303 <code> <url>
3688 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3690 yes | yes | yes | yes
3691 Arguments :
3692 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003693 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3694 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003695
3696 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3697 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3698 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3699 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003700 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003701
3702 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3703 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3704 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3705
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003706 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003708 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3709 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3710 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3711 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003712 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003713
3714 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3715
3716
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003717email-alert from <emailaddr>
3718 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003719 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3721 yes | yes | yes | yes
3722
3723 Arguments :
3724
3725 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3726
3727 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3728 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3729
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003730 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003731 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3732 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003733
3734
3735email-alert level <level>
3736 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3737 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3738 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | yes
3740
3741 Arguments :
3742
3743 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3744 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3745 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3746
3747 By default level is alert
3748
3749 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3750 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3751 for the proxy.
3752
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003753 Alerts are sent when :
3754
3755 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3756 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3757 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3758 is notice or lower
3759 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3760 and a health check status update occurs
3761
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003762 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3763 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003764 section 3.6 about mailers.
3765
3766
3767email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3768 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3769 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3770 yes | yes | yes | yes
3771
3772 Arguments :
3773
3774 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3775
3776 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3777 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3778
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003779 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3780 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003781
3782
3783email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3784 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3785 mailers.
3786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3787 yes | yes | yes | yes
3788
3789 Arguments :
3790
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003791 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003792
3793 By default the systems hostname is used.
3794
3795 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3796 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3797 for the proxy.
3798
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003799 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3800 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003801
3802
3803email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003804 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003805 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3806 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3807 yes | yes | yes | yes
3808
3809 Arguments :
3810
3811 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3812
3813 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3814 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3815
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003816 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003817 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3818
3819
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003820force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3821 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3822 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003823 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003824
3825 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3826 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3827 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3828 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3829 marked down for maintenance operations.
3830
3831 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3832 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3833 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3834 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3835 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3836 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3837 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3838 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3839 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3840
3841 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3842 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3843 is used.
3844
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003845 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003846 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003847
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003848
3849filter <name> [param*]
3850 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3852 no | yes | yes | yes
3853 Arguments :
3854 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3855 referenced in section 9.
3856
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003857 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003858 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003859 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3860 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003861
3862 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3863 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3864
3865 Example:
3866 listen
3867 bind *:80
3868
3869 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3870 filter compression
3871 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3872
3873 compression algo gzip
3874 compression offload
3875
3876 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3877
3878 See also : section 9.
3879
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003880
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003881fullconn <conns>
3882 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3884 yes | no | yes | yes
3885 Arguments :
3886 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3887 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3888
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003889 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003891 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003892 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3893 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3894 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3895 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3896 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003897 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003898
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003899 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3900 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003901 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3902 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3903 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003904
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003905 Example :
3906 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3907 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3908 # connections.
3909 backend dynamic
3910 fullconn 10000
3911 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3912 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3913
3914 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3915
3916
3917grace <time>
3918 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003920 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003921 Arguments :
3922 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3923 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3924 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3925
3926 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3927 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003928 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003929 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3930
3931 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3932 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3933 simplify it.
3934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003935
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003936hash-balance-factor <factor>
3937 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3939 yes | no | no | yes
3940 Arguments :
3941 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3942 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003943 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003944
3945 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3946 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3947 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3948 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3949 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3950 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3951 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3952
3953 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3954 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3955 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3956 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3957 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3958
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003959 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3960 consistent hashing mechanism.
3961
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003962 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3963
3964
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003965hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003966 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3968 yes | no | yes | yes
3969 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003970 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3971 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003972
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003973 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3974 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3975 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3976 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3977 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3978 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3979 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3980 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3981 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3982 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003983
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003984 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3985 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3986 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3987 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3988 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3989 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3990 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3991 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3992 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3993 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3994 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3995 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3996 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003997 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3998 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003999
4000 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4001
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004002 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004003 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4004 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4005 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004006 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4007 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4008 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004009
4010 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4011 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004012 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4013 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4014 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4015 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4016
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004017 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4018 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4019 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4020 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4021 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4022 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4023 parameter.
4024
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004025 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4026 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4027 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4028 used on strings.
4029
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004030 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4031
4032 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4033 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4034 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4035 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4036 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4037 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4038 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4039 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4040 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4041 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4042 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4043 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004044
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004045 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4046 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4047 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004048
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004049 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004050
4051
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004052http-check disable-on-404
4053 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004055 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004056 Arguments : none
4057
4058 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4059 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4060 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4061 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4062 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4063 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4064 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4065 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004066 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4067 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4068 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4069
4070 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4071
4072
4073http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004074 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004076 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004077 Arguments :
4078 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4079 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004080 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004081 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4082 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4083 details on the supported keywords.
4084
4085 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4086 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4087 with the usual backslash ('\').
4088
4089 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4090 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4091 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4092 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4093 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4094
4095 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004096 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004097 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4098 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4099 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4100
4101 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004102 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004103 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4104 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4105 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4106 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4107
4108 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004109 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004110 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4111 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4112 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4113 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4114 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004115 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004116 trace).
4117
4118 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004119 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004120 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4121 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4122 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4123 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4124 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004125 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004126
4127 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4128 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4129 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4130 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4131 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4132 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4133 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4134 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4135
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004136 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4137 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4138 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4139
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004140 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4141 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4142
4143 Examples :
4144 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004145 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004146
4147 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004148 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004149
4150 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004151 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004152
4153 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004154 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004155
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004156 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004157
4158
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004159http-check send-state
4160 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4162 yes | no | yes | yes
4163 Arguments : none
4164
4165 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4166 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4167 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4168 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4169 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4170
4171 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4172 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4173 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4174 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4175 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004176 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4177 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4178 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4179
4180 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4181 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4182 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4183
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004184 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4185 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4186 checked in multiple backends.
4187
4188 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4189 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4190
4191 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4192 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4193 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4194 one fails.
4195
4196 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4197 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4198 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4199
4200 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4201 server's queue.
4202
4203 Example of a header received by the application server :
4204 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4205 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4206
4207 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004209
4210http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004211 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4212
4213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4214 no | yes | yes | yes
4215
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004216 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4217 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4218 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4219 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4220 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004222 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4223 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004227 Example:
4228 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4229 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4230 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232 http-request allow if nagios
4233 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4234 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4235 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004236
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004237 Example:
4238 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4239 acl add path /addacl
4240 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004244 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4245 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004247 Example:
4248 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4249 acl setmap path /setmap
4250 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004254 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4255 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004257 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4258 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004259
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004260http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4263 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4264 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4265 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4266 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4267 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4268 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4269 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004271http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004273 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4274 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4275 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4276 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4277 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4278 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4279 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4280 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4285 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004286
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004288http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4291 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4292 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4293 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4294 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004296 Example:
4297 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4298 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004299
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004300http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004301
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004302 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004304http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4305 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4308 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4309 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4310 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4311 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4312 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4313 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4314 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4315 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004317 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4318 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4319 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4320 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4321 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4322 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4327 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4328 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4329 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4330 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4331 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004333http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004338
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004339 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4340 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4341 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4342 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4343 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4344 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004346http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4349 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4350 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4351 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4352 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004353
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004354http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4355 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4356 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4357 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4358
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004359http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4360
4361 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4362 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4363 pointed by <resolvers>.
4364 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4365 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4366 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4367 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4368 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4369 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4370 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4371 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4372 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4373 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4374 to 0.0.0.0.
4375
4376 Example:
4377 resolvers mydns
4378 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4379 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4380 timeout retry 1s
4381 hold valid 10s
4382 hold nx 3s
4383 hold other 3s
4384 hold obsolete 0s
4385 accepted_payload_size 8192
4386
4387 frontend fe
4388 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4389 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4390 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4391
4392 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4393 # which mean DNS resolution error
4394 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4395
4396 default_backend be
4397
4398 backend b_503
4399 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4400 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4401 # 503 error page to end users
4402
4403 backend be
4404 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4405 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4406 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4407 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4408 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4409
4410 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4411 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4412
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004413http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4414
4415 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4416 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4417 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4418 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004419 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4420 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004421
4422 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004426 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4427 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4428 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4429 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4430 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004432http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004434 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4435 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4436 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4437 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004439http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4440 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004441
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004442 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4443 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4444 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4445 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4446 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4447 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004448
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004449 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4450 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4451 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4452 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4453 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004454
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004455 Example:
4456 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4457
4458 # applied to:
4459 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4460
4461 # outputs:
4462 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4463
4464 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004465
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004466 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4467
4468 # applied to:
4469 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004470
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004471 # outputs:
4472 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004473
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004474http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4475 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4476
4477 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4478 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4479 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4480 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4481
4482 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4483 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4484 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4485
4486 Example:
4487 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4488 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4489
4490 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4491 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4492
4493 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4494 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4495 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4496 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4497
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004498http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4499 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4500
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004501 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4502 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4503 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4504 against.
4505
4506 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4507 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4508 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004509
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004510 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4511 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4512 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4513 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4514 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4515 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4516 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4517 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4518 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004519 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4520 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004521
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004522 Example:
4523 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4524 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004525
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004526 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4527 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004528
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004529http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4530 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004531
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004532 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4533 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4534 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4535 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004536
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004537 Example:
4538 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004539
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004540 # applied to:
4541 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004542
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004543 # outputs:
4544 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004546http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4547http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4550 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4551 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004552
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004553http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4554 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004555
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004556 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4557 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4558 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4559 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004561http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004563 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4564 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4565 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4566 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4567 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569 Arguments:
4570 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4571 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573 Example:
4574 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4575 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004577 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4578 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004580http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4583 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4584 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586 Arguments:
4587 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4588 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004590 Example:
4591 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4592 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004594 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4595 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4596 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004598http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004600 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4601 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4602 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4603 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4604 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606 Example:
4607 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4608 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4609 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4610 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4611 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4612 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4613 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4614 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4615 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4620 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4621 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4622 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4623 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4626 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004628 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4629 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4630 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4631 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4632 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4633 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4634 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4635 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4636 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004638http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004640 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4641 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4642 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4643 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4644 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4645 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4646 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004650 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4651 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4652 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004656 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4657 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4658 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4659 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4660 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4661 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4662 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4663 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004665http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004667 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4668 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4669 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4670 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4671 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4672 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 Example :
4675 # prepend the host name before the path
4676 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004678http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004680 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4681 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4682 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4683 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4684 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004686http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004688 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4689 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4690 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4691 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4692 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4693 values have higher priority.
4694 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4695 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4696 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4697 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4698 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004700http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004702 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4703 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4704 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4705 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4706 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4707 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4708 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004710 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004711
4712 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004713 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4714 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004716http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4717 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4718 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4719 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4720 privacy.
4721
4722 Arguments :
4723 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4724 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004725
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004726 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004727 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4728 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4729
4730 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4731 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4732
4733http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4734
4735 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4736 expression.
4737
4738 Arguments:
4739 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4740 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004741
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004742 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004743 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4744 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4745
4746 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4747 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4748 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4749
4750http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4751
4752 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4753 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4754 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4755 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4756 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4757 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4758 information from the request.
4759
4760 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4761
4762http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4763
4764 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4765 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4766 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4767 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4768 path and the query string.
4769 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4770
4771http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4772
4773 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4774 inline.
4775
4776 Arguments:
4777 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4778 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4779 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4780 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4781 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4782 (request and response)
4783 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4784 processing
4785 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4786 processing
4787 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4788 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4789 and '_'.
4790
4791 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4792 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004793
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004794 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004795 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004796
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004797http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4798 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004799
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004800 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4801 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4802 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4803 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4804 agent name must be used.
4805
4806 Arguments:
4807 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4808
4809 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4810 configuration.
4811
4812http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4813
4814 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4815 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4816 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4817 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4818 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4819 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4820 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4821 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4822 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4823 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4824 action.
4825 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4826 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4827 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4828 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4829 you fully understand how it works.
4830
4831http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4832
4833 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4834 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4835 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4836 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4837 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4838 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4839 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4840 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4841 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4842 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4843 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4844 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4845 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4846
4847http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4848http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4849http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4850
4851 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4852 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4853 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4854 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4855 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4856 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4857 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4858 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4859 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4860 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4861 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4862 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4863
4864 Arguments :
4865 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4866 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4867 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4868 select which table entry to update the counters.
4869
4870 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4871 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4872 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4873 that table until the session ends.
4874
4875 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4876 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4877 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4878 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4879 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4880 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4881 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4882 useful information.
4883
4884 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4885 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4886 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4887 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4888 checks that make use of it.
4889
4890http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4891
4892 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004893
4894 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004895 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004896
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004897http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4898
4899 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4900 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4901 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4902 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4903 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4904 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4905
4906 Arguments :
4907 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4908
4909 Example:
4910 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4911
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004912http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004914 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4915 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4916 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004917
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004918
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004919http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004920 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4921
4922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4923 no | yes | yes | yes
4924
4925 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4926 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4927 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4928 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4929 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4930 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004932 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4933 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004934
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004935 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004937 Example:
4938 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004940 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004942 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4943 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004945 Example:
4946 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004948 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004950 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4951 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004952
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004953 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4954 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004956http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004958 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4959 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4960 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4961 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4962 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4963 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4964 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4965 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004967http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004969 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4970 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4971 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4972 example, or to pass some internal information.
4973 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4974 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4975 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004977http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004979 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4980 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004981
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004982http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004983
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004984 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004986http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004988 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4989 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4990 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4991 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4992 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4993 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4994 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004996 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4997 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4998 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4999 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5000 keyword.
5001 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
5002 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005003
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005004http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005006 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5007 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5008 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5009 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5010 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5011 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005012
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005013http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005015 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005017http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005019 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5020 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5021 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5022 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5023 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5024 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005025
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005026http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005028 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5029 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005031http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005033 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5034 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5035 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5036 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5037 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5038 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005040http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5041 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005042
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005043 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5044 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005046 Example:
5047 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005049 # applied to:
5050 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005052 # outputs:
5053 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005055 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005057http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5058 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005059
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005060 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005061 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005062
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005063 Example:
5064 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005066 # applied to:
5067 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005069 # outputs:
5070 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005072http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5073http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005075 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5076 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5077 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005078
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005079http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5080 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005081
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005082 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5083 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5084 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5085 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005087http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005089 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5090 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5091 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5092 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5093 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005095 Arguments:
5096 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005098 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5099 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005101http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005103 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5104 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5105 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005107http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5108
5109 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5110 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5111 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5112 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5113 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5114
5115http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5116
5117 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5118 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5119 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5120 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5121 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5122 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5123 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5124 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5125 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5126
5127http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5128
5129 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5130 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5131 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5132 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5133 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5134 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5135 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5136
5137http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5138
5139 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5140 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5141 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5142 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5143 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5144 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5145 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5146 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5147
5148http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5149 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5150
5151 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5152 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5153 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5154 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005155
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005156 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005157 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5158 http-response set-status 431
5159 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5160 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005161
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005162http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005164 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5165 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5166 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5167 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5168 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5169 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5170 based on some information from the request.
5171
5172 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5173
5174http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5175
5176 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5177 inline.
5178
5179 Arguments:
5180 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5181 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5182 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5183 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5184 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5185 (request and response)
5186 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5187 processing
5188 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5189 processing
5190 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5191 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5192 and '_'.
5193
5194 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5195 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005196
5197 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005198 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005200http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005202 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5203 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5204 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5205 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5206 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5207 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5208 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5209 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5210 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5211 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5212 action.
5213 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5214 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5215 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5216 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5217 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005219http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5220http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5221http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005222
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005223 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5224 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5225 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5226 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5227 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5228 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5229
5230http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5231
5232 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5233 about <var-name>.
5234
5235 Example:
5236 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5237
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005238
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005239http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5240 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5241
5242 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5243 yes | no | yes | yes
5244
5245 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005246 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5247 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5248 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005249
5250 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5251
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005252 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5253 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5254 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5255 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5256 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5257 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5258 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5259 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5260 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5261 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005262
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005263 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5264 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5265 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5266 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5267 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5268 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5269 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5270 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005271
5272 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5273 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5274 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5275 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5276 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5277 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5278 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5279 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005280 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005281 downsides of rare connection failures.
5282
5283 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5284 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5285 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5286 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5287 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5288 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005289 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005290 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5291 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5292 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5293 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5294 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5295
5296 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005297 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5298 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5299 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005300
5301 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005302 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005303
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005304 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5305 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005306
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005307 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005308
5309 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5310 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5311 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5312
5313 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5314
5315
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005316http-send-name-header [<header>]
5317 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005318 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5319 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005320 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005321 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5322
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005323 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5324 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5325 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5326 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5327 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5328 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5329 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5330 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5331 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5332 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5333 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5334 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5335 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5336 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5337 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5338 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005339
5340 See also : "server"
5341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005342id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005343 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5345 no | yes | yes | yes
5346 Arguments : none
5347
5348 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5349 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5350 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005351
5352
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005353ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5354 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5355 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005356 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005357
5358 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5359 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5360 and running).
5361
5362 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5363 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5364 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005365 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005366 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5367
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005368 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5369 "unless" condition is met.
5370
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005371 Example:
5372 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5373 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5374 ignore-persist if url_static
5375
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005376 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5377
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005378load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5379 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5380 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5381 yes | no | yes | yes
5382
5383 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5384 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5385 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005386 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005387 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5388 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5389 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5390 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5391
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005392 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005393 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005394 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005395
5396 Arguments:
5397 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5398 named "server-state-file".
5399
5400 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5401 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5402 name is used as a file name.
5403
5404 none don't load any stat for this backend
5405
5406 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005407 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5408 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5409 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005410 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005411 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005412
5413 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5414 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5415
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005416 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005417
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005418 global
5419 stats socket /tmp/socket
5420 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005421
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005422 defaults
5423 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005424
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005425 backend bk
5426 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5427 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005428
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005429
5430 Then one can run :
5431
5432 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5433
5434 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5435
5436 1
5437 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5438 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5439 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5440
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005441 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005442
5443 global
5444 stats socket /tmp/socket
5445 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5446
5447 defaults
5448 load-server-state-from-file local
5449
5450 backend bk
5451 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5452 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5453
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005454
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005455 Then one can run :
5456
5457 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5458
5459 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5460
5461 1
5462 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5463 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5464 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5465
5466 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5467 "show servers state"
5468
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005469
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005470log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005471log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5472 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005473no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005474 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5476 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005477
5478 Prefix :
5479 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5480 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5481 prefix does not allow arguments.
5482
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005483 Arguments :
5484 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5485 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5486 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5487 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5488 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5489 parameter.
5490
5491 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5492 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5493
5494 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5495 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5496 standard syslog port).
5497
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005498 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5499 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5500 standard syslog port).
5501
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005502 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5503 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5504 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005505 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005506
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005507 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5508 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5509 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5510 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5511 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5512 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5513 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5514 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5515 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5516 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5517 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5518 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5519 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5520 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5521 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5522 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005523 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5524 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005525
5526 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5527 and "fd@2", see above.
5528
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005529 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5530 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5531 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5532 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5533 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5534 having the logs instantly available.
5535
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005536 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5537 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005538
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005539 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5540 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5541 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5542 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5543 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5544 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5545 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5546 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5547 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5548 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005549 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005550
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005551 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5552 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5553 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5554 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5555 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5556
5557 <sample_size>
5558 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5559 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5560 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5561 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5562 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5563
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005564 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5565 one of the following :
5566
5567 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5568 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5569
5570 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5571 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5572
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005573 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5574 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5575 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5576 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5577 systemd logger consumes.
5578
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005579 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5580 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5581 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5582 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5583
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005584 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5585
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005586 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5587 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5588 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5589
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005590 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5591 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5592 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5593 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005594
5595 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5596 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5597 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005598 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5599 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5600 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5601 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5602 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005603
5604 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5605
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005606 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5607 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5608 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005609
5610 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5611 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5612 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5613 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5614
5615 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5616 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005617
5618 Example :
5619 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005620 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5621 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5622 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005623 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5624 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005625 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005626
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005627
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005628log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005629 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5630 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5631 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005632
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005633 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5634 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5635 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5636 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5637 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005638
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005639 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5640 "option httplog" directives.
5641
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005642log-format-sd <string>
5643 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5644 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 yes | yes | yes | no
5646
5647 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5648 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5649 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5650 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5651 which covers the log format string in depth.
5652
5653 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5654 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5655
5656 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5657 log format to "rfc5424".
5658
5659 Example :
5660 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5661
5662
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005663log-tag <string>
5664 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5666 yes | yes | yes | yes
5667
5668 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5669 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5670 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5671 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5672 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5673 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5674 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5675 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5676 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005677
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005678max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5679 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5681 yes | no | yes | yes
5682
5683 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5684 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5685 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5686 servers.
5687
5688 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5689 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5690 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5691 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5692 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005693 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005694 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5695 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5696 picking a different server.
5697
5698 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5699 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5700 even if they have to be queued.
5701
5702 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5703 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5704
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005705max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5706 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5707 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5708 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005709
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005710maxconn <conns>
5711 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5713 yes | yes | yes | no
5714 Arguments :
5715 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5716 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5717 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5718 closes.
5719
5720 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5721 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5722 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5723 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005724 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5725 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5726 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5727 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005728
5729 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5730 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5731 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5732
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005733 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5734 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005735
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005736 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5737
5738
5739mode { tcp|http|health }
5740 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5742 yes | yes | yes | yes
5743 Arguments :
5744 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5745 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5746 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5747 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5748
5749 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5750 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5751 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5752 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5753 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5754
5755 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005756 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5757 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5758 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5759 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5760 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5761 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5762 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005763
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005764 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5765 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5766 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005767
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005768 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005769 defaults http_instances
5770 mode http
5771
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005772 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005773
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005774
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005775monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005776 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5778 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005779 Arguments :
5780 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5781 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005782 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005783 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5784 backend and its backup.
5785
5786 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5787 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5788 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5789 servers in a list of backends.
5790
5791 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5792 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5793 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5794 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5795 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5796 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5797 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005798 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5799 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005800
5801 Example:
5802 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005803 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005804 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5805 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5806 monitor-uri /site_alive
5807 monitor fail if site_dead
5808
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005809 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005810
5811
5812monitor-net <source>
5813 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5815 yes | yes | yes | no
5816 Arguments :
5817 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5818 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5819 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5820 followed by a mask.
5821
5822 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5823 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005824 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005825 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5826
5827 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5828 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5829 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5830 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005831 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5832 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5833 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005834
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005835 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5836 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5837 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5838 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5839 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5840 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005841
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005842 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5843 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005844
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005845 Example :
5846 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5847 frontend www
5848 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5849
5850 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5851
5852
5853monitor-uri <uri>
5854 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5856 yes | yes | yes | no
5857 Arguments :
5858 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5859 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5860
5861 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5862 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5863 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5864 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5865 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5866 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5867 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5868 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5869
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005870 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005871 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5872 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5873 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5874 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5875 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5876 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005877
5878 Example :
5879 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5880 frontend www
5881 mode http
5882 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5883
5884 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5885
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005886
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005887option abortonclose
5888no option abortonclose
5889 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5891 yes | no | yes | yes
5892 Arguments : none
5893
5894 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5895 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5896 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5897 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005898 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005899 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5900 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5901 encountered while delivering the response.
5902
5903 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5904 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5905 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5906 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5907 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5908 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005909 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005910 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005911 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005912 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5913 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5914 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5915
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005916 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5917 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005918 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5919 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5920 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5921 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5922 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5923 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005924 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005925
5926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5928
5929 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5930
5931
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005932option accept-invalid-http-request
5933no option accept-invalid-http-request
5934 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5936 yes | yes | yes | no
5937 Arguments : none
5938
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005939 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005940 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005941 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005942 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5943 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5944 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5945 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5946 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005947 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5948 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5949 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5950 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005951 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005952 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005953 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5954 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5955 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005956
5957 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5958 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5959 been confirmed.
5960
5961 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5962 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005963 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5964 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005965 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5966
5967 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5968 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5969
5970 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5971 stats socket.
5972
5973
5974option accept-invalid-http-response
5975no option accept-invalid-http-response
5976 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5978 yes | no | yes | yes
5979 Arguments : none
5980
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005981 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005982 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005983 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005984 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5985 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5986 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5987 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5988 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005989 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5990 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5991 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005992
5993 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5994 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5995 been confirmed.
5996
5997 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5998 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5999 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6000 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6001
6002 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6003 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6004
6005 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6006 stats socket.
6007
6008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006009option allbackups
6010no option allbackups
6011 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6013 yes | no | yes | yes
6014 Arguments : none
6015
6016 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6017 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6018 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6019 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6020 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6021 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6022 order between the backup servers anymore.
6023
6024 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6025 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6026
6027 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6028 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6029
6030
6031option checkcache
6032no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006033 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6035 yes | no | yes | yes
6036 Arguments : none
6037
6038 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6039 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006040 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006041 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6042 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006043 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006044
6045 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006046 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006047 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006048 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6049 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006050 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006051 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006052 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6053 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006054 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006055 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6056 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006057 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006058 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6059 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6060 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6061 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6062 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6063 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6064 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6065 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6066 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6067
6068 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006069 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6070 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6071 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6072 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006073
6074 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6075 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006076 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006077 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006078
6079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6081
6082
6083option clitcpka
6084no option clitcpka
6085 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6087 yes | yes | yes | no
6088 Arguments : none
6089
6090 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6091 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006092 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006093 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6094
6095 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6096 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6097 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6098 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6099
6100 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6101 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6102 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6103 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6104 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6105
6106 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6107
6108 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6109 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6110 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6111
6112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6114
6115 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6116
6117
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006118option contstats
6119 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6121 yes | yes | yes | no
6122 Arguments : none
6123
6124 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6125 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6126 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6127 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006128 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6129 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6130 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6131 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6132 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006133
6134
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006135option dontlog-normal
6136no option dontlog-normal
6137 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6139 yes | yes | yes | no
6140 Arguments : none
6141
6142 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6143 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6144 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6145 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6146 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6147 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6148 logged.
6149
6150 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6151 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6152 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006154 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006155 logging.
6156
6157
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006158option dontlognull
6159no option dontlognull
6160 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6162 yes | yes | yes | no
6163 Arguments : none
6164
6165 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6166 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6167 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6168 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6169 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6170 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006171 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6172 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6173 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006174
6175 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006176 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006177 would not be logged.
6178
6179 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6180 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6181
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006182 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6183 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006184
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006185
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006186option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006187 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6189 yes | yes | yes | yes
6190 Arguments :
6191 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6192 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006193 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006194 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006195
6196 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6197 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6198 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6199 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6200 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6201 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6202 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006203 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6204 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6205 possible that the client has already brought one.
6206
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006207 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006208 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006209 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006210 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006211 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006212 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006213
6214 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6215 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6216 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6217 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6218 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6219 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6220 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6221
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006222 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6223 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6224 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6225 are under the control of the end-user.
6226
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006227 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006228 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6229 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006230 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6231 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6232 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006233
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006234 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006235 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6236 frontend www
6237 mode http
6238 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6239
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006240 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6241 backend www
6242 mode http
6243 option forwardfor header X-Client
6244
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006245 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006246 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006247
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006248
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006249option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6250no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6251 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6253 yes | yes | yes | no
6254 Arguments : none
6255
6256 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6257 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6258 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6259 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6260 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6261 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6262 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6263
6264 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6265 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6266 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6267 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6268 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6269 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6270 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6271 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6272 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6273 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6274
6275 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6276
6277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6279
6280 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6281 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6282
6283
6284option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6285no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6286 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6288 yes | no | yes | yes
6289 Arguments : none
6290
6291 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6292 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6293 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6294 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6295 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6296 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6297 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6298
6299 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6300 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6301 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6302 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6303 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6304 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6305 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6306 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6307 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6308 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6309
6310 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6311
6312 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6313 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6314
6315 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6316 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6317
6318
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006319option http-buffer-request
6320no option http-buffer-request
6321 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6323 yes | yes | yes | yes
6324 Arguments : none
6325
6326 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6327 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6328 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6329 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6330 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6331 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006332 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6333 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6334 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6335 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006336
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006337 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006338
6339
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006340option http-ignore-probes
6341no option http-ignore-probes
6342 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6344 yes | yes | yes | no
6345 Arguments : none
6346
6347 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6348 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6349 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6350 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6351 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6352 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6353 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6354 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6355 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006356 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6357 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006358 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6359
6360 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6361 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6362 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6363 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6364 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6365 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6366 are often the only way to detect them.
6367
6368 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6369 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6370
6371 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6372
6373
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006374option http-keep-alive
6375no option http-keep-alive
6376 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6378 yes | yes | yes | yes
6379 Arguments : none
6380
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006381 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6382 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006383 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6384 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006385 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6386 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6387 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006388
6389 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6390 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006391 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6392 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6393 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6394 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6395 situations where this option may be useful :
6396
6397 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006398 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006399
6400 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6401 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6402
6403 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6404 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6405 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6406 request.
6407
6408 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6409 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006410 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6411 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6412 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006413
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006414 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6415 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6416 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6417 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6418 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6419 not set.
6420
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006421 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6422 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6423 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006424
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006425 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006426 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006427 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006428
6429
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006430option http-no-delay
6431no option http-no-delay
6432 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6434 yes | yes | yes | yes
6435 Arguments : none
6436
6437 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6438 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6439 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6440 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6441 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6442 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6443 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6444 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6445 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6446 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6447 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6448 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6449 affected.
6450
6451 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6452 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6453 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6454 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6455 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6456 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6457 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6458 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6459 latency environments.
6460
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006461 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6462
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006463
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006464option http-pretend-keepalive
6465no option http-pretend-keepalive
6466 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006468 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006469 Arguments : none
6470
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006471 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006472 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6473 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6474 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6475 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6476 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6477 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6478 consider the response complete.
6479
6480 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6481 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6482 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6483 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006484 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006485 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6486
6487 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6488 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6489 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6490 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6491 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6492 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6493 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6494
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006495 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6496 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6497 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6498 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6499 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6500 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006501
6502 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6503 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6504
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006505 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006506 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006507
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006508
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006509option http-server-close
6510no option http-server-close
6511 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6513 yes | yes | yes | yes
6514 Arguments : none
6515
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006516 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6517 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6518 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6519 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006520 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6521 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6522 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6523 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6524 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6525 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6526 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6527 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6528 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6529 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6530 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006531
6532 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6533 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6534 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6535 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006536 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6537 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006538
6539 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6540 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006541 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6542 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6543 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006544
6545 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6546 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6547
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006548 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6549 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006550
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006551option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006552no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006553 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6555 yes | yes | yes | no
6556 Arguments : none
6557
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006558 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006559 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6560 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6561 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6562 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6563 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6564 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6565
6566 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6567 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006568 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6569 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6570 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006571
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006572 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6573 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6574 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6575 front of an existing proxy.
6576
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006577 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6578
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006579 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006580
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006581option httpchk
6582option httpchk <uri>
6583option httpchk <method> <uri>
6584option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6585 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6587 yes | no | yes | yes
6588 Arguments :
6589 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6590 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6591 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6592 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6593 ones.
6594
6595 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6596 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6597 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6598
6599 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6600 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6601 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6602 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6603 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6604
6605 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6606 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6607 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6608 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6609 the lack of any response.
6610
6611 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6612
6613 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6614 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6615 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6616
6617 Examples :
6618 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6619 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6620 backend https_relay
6621 mode tcp
6622 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6623 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6624
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006625 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6626 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6627 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006628
6629
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006630option httpclose
6631no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006632 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6634 yes | yes | yes | yes
6635 Arguments : none
6636
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006637 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6638 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6639 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6640 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006641 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006642
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006643 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6644 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006645 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006646 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6647 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006648
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006649 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6650 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6651 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006652
6653 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6654 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006655 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6656 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6657 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006658
6659 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6660 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6661
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006662 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006663
6664
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006665option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006666 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006668 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006669 Arguments :
6670 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6671 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6672 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006673 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006674 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006675
6676 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6677 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6678 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6679 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6680 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6681 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6682 ports.
6683
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006684 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6685 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006686
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006687 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006689 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006690
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006691
6692option http_proxy
6693no option http_proxy
6694 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6696 yes | yes | yes | yes
6697 Arguments : none
6698
6699 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6700 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6701 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6702 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6703 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6704
6705 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6706 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006707 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6708 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006709
6710 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6711 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6712
6713 Example :
6714 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6715 backend direct_forward
6716 option httpclose
6717 option http_proxy
6718
6719 See also : "option httpclose"
6720
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006721
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006722option independent-streams
6723no option independent-streams
6724 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6726 yes | yes | yes | yes
6727 Arguments : none
6728
6729 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6730 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6731 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6732 receive data or not.
6733
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006734 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006735 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6736 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6737 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6738 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6739 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6740 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6741 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6742 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6743 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6744 socket buffers.
6745
6746 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6747 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6748 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6749 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6750 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6751
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006752 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006753
6754
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006755option ldap-check
6756 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6758 yes | no | yes | yes
6759 Arguments : none
6760
6761 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6762 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6763 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6764 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6765
6766 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6767 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6768
6769 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6770 configure it.
6771
6772 Example :
6773 option ldap-check
6774
6775 See also : "option httpchk"
6776
6777
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006778option external-check
6779 Use external processes for server health checks
6780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6781 yes | no | yes | yes
6782
6783 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6784 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6785 command".
6786
6787 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6788
6789 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6790
6791
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006792option log-health-checks
6793no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006794 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6796 yes | no | yes | yes
6797 Arguments : none
6798
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006799 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6800 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6801 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006802
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006803 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6804 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6805 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6806 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6807 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6808
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006809 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006810 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006811
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006812 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6813 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6814 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006815
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006816
6817option log-separate-errors
6818no option log-separate-errors
6819 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6821 yes | yes | yes | no
6822 Arguments : none
6823
6824 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6825 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6826 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6827 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6828 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6829 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6830 provides very important information.
6831
6832 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6833 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6834 error logs.
6835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006836 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006837 logging.
6838
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006839
6840option logasap
6841no option logasap
6842 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6844 yes | yes | yes | no
6845 Arguments : none
6846
6847 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6848 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6849 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6850 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6851 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6852 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6853 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006854 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006855 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6856 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6857
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006858 Examples :
6859 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6860 mode http
6861 option httplog
6862 option logasap
6863 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6864
6865 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6866 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6867 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6868 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006870 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006871 logging.
6872
6873
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006874option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006875 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6877 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006878 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006879 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6880 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006881 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006882
6883 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6884 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006885 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006886 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6887 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6888 in the MySQL table, like this :
6889
6890 USE mysql;
6891 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6892 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6893
6894 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006895 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006896 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6897 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6898 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6899 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6900 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6901 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6902 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6903
6904 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6905 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006906
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006907 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006908
6909 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6910 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6911 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6912 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006913 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6914 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006915
6916 See also: "option httpchk"
6917
6918
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006919option nolinger
6920no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006921 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6923 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006924 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006925
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006926 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006927 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6928 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6929 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6930 connections.
6931
6932 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6933 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6934 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6935 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6936 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6937 this too.
6938
6939 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6940 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6941 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6942
6943 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6944 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6945 for servers.
6946
6947 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6948 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6949
6950
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006951option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6952 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6954 yes | yes | yes | yes
6955 Arguments :
6956 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6957 matching <network>
6958 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6959 header name.
6960
6961 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6962 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6963 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6964 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6965 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6966 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6967 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6968 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6969 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6970 possible that the client has already brought one.
6971
6972 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6973 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6974 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6975 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6976 header and requires different one.
6977
6978 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6979 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6980 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6981 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6982 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6983 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6984 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6985
6986 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6987 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6988 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6989 both are defined.
6990
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006991 Examples :
6992 # Original Destination address
6993 frontend www
6994 mode http
6995 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6996
6997 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6998 backend www
6999 mode http
7000 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7001
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007002 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007003
7004
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007005option persist
7006no option persist
7007 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7009 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007010 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007011
7012 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7013 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7014 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7015 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7016 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7017 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7018 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7019 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7020 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7021 redirected to another valid server.
7022
7023 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7024 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7025
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007026 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007027
7028
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007029option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7030 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7032 yes | no | yes | yes
7033 Arguments :
7034 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7035 PostgreSQL server.
7036
7037 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7038 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7039 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7040 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7041
7042 See also: "option httpchk"
7043
7044
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007045option prefer-last-server
7046no option prefer-last-server
7047 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7049 yes | no | yes | yes
7050 Arguments : none
7051
7052 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7053 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7054 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7055 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7056 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7057 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7058 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7059 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7060 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007061 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7062 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007063 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7064 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7065 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007066 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7067 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7068 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007069
7070 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7071 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7072
7073 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7074
7075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007076option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007077option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007078no option redispatch
7079 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7081 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007082 Arguments :
7083 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7084 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7085 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007086 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007087 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007088 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007089 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7090 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7091 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007093
7094 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7095 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7096 be able to access the service anymore.
7097
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007098 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7099 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007100
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007101 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007102 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7103 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7107
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007108 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007109
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007110
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007111option redis-check
7112 Use redis health checks for server testing
7113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7114 yes | no | yes | yes
7115 Arguments : none
7116
7117 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7118 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7119 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7120 find the "+PONG" response message.
7121
7122 Example :
7123 option redis-check
7124
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007125 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007126
7127
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007128option smtpchk
7129option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7130 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7132 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007133 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007134 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007135 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007136 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7137
7138 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7139 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7140 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7141
7142 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7143 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7144 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7145 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7146 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7147 dead server.
7148
7149 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7150 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007151 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007152 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7153
7154 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7155 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7156 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7157 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007158 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007159
7160 Example :
7161 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7162
7163 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7164
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007166option socket-stats
7167no option socket-stats
7168
7169 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7171 yes | yes | yes | no
7172
7173 Arguments : none
7174
7175
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007176option splice-auto
7177no option splice-auto
7178 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7180 yes | yes | yes | yes
7181 Arguments : none
7182
7183 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7184 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007185 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007186 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007187 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007188 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7189 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7190 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7191 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7192
7193 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7194 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7195 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7196 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7197 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7198 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7199 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7200 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7201 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7202 keyword.
7203
7204 Example :
7205 option splice-auto
7206
7207 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7208 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7209
7210 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7211 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7212
7213
7214option splice-request
7215no option splice-request
7216 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7218 yes | yes | yes | yes
7219 Arguments : none
7220
7221 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007222 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007223 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7224 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7225 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7226 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7227
7228 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7229
7230 Example :
7231 option splice-request
7232
7233 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7234 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7235
7236 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7237 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7238
7239
7240option splice-response
7241no option splice-response
7242 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7244 yes | yes | yes | yes
7245 Arguments : none
7246
7247 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007248 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007249 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7250 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7251 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7252 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7253
7254 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7255
7256 Example :
7257 option splice-response
7258
7259 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7260 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7261
7262 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7263 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7264
7265
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007266option spop-check
7267 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7269 no | no | no | yes
7270 Arguments : none
7271
7272 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7273 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7274 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7275 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7276
7277 Example :
7278 option spop-check
7279
7280 See also : "option httpchk"
7281
7282
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007283option srvtcpka
7284no option srvtcpka
7285 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7287 yes | no | yes | yes
7288 Arguments : none
7289
7290 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7291 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007292 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007293 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7294
7295 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7296 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7297 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7298 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7299
7300 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7301 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7302 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7303 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7304 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7305
7306 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7307
7308 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7309 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7310 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7311
7312 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7313 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7314
7315 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7316
7317
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007318option ssl-hello-chk
7319 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7321 yes | no | yes | yes
7322 Arguments : none
7323
7324 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7325 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7326 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7327 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7328 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7329 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7330 hello message.
7331
7332 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7333 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7334 messages, which is appreciable.
7335
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007336 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7337 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7338 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007339
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007340 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7341
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007342
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007343option tcp-check
7344 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7345 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7346 yes | no | yes | yes
7347
7348 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7349 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7350
7351 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7352 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7353 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7354
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007355 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007356 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7357 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7358 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7359 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7360 only.
7361
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007362 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007363 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7364 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7365 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7366 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7367
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007368 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007369 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7370 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007371 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007372 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7373 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7374 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7375 the respective protocols.
7376 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007377 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007378
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007379 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7380 script.
7381
7382 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7383 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7384 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7385 The "comment" is of course optional.
7386
7387
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007388 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007389 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007390 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007391 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007392
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007393 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007394 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007395 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007396
7397 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7398 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007399 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007400 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007401 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007402 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007403 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007404 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007405 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7406 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007407 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007408 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7409 tcp-check expect string +OK
7410
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007411 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007412 (send many headers before analyzing)
7413 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007414 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007415 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7416 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7417 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7418 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007419 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007420
7421
7422 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7423
7424
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007425option tcp-smart-accept
7426no option tcp-smart-accept
7427 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7429 yes | yes | yes | no
7430 Arguments : none
7431
7432 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7433 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7434 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7435 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7436 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7437 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7438
7439 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7440 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7441 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7442 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7443
7444 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7445 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7446 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007447 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007448
7449 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7450 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7451 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7452
7453 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7454 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7455 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7456
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007457 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7458
7459
7460option tcp-smart-connect
7461no option tcp-smart-connect
7462 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7464 yes | no | yes | yes
7465 Arguments : none
7466
7467 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7468 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7469 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7470 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7471 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7472
7473 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7474 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7475 complex.
7476
7477 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7478 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7479 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7480
7481 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7482 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7483
7484 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7485
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007486
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007487option tcpka
7488 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7490 yes | yes | yes | yes
7491 Arguments : none
7492
7493 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7494 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007495 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007496 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7497
7498 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7499 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7500 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7501 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7502
7503 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7504 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7505 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7506 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7507 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7508
7509 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7510
7511 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7512 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7513 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7514 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7515 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7516 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7517 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7518 backends.
7519
7520 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7521
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007522
7523option tcplog
7524 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007526 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007527 Arguments : none
7528
7529 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7530 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7531 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7532 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7533 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7534 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7535 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7536 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7537
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007538 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007540 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007541
7542
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007543option transparent
7544no option transparent
7545 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007547 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007548 Arguments : none
7549
7550 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7551 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7552 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7553 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7554 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7555 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7556 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7557 appropriate server.
7558
7559 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7560 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7561
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007562 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007563 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007564
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007565
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007566external-check command <command>
7567 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7569 yes | no | yes | yes
7570
7571 Arguments :
7572 <command> is the external command to run
7573
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007574 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7575
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007576 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007577
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007578 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7579 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7580 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7581 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7582 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7583 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007584
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007585 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7586
7587 Environment variables :
7588 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7589 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7590
7591 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7592
7593 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7594
7595 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7596 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7597 for a UNIX socket).
7598
7599 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7600
7601 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7602
7603 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7604
7605 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7606
7607 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7608
7609 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7610 socket).
7611
7612 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7613 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7614
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007615 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7616
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007617 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7618 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7619 failed.
7620
7621 Example :
7622 external-check command /bin/true
7623
7624 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7625
7626
7627external-check path <path>
7628 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7630 yes | no | yes | yes
7631
7632 Arguments :
7633 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7634
7635 The default path is "".
7636
7637 Example :
7638 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7639
7640 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7641 "external-check command"
7642
7643
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007644persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007645persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007646 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7648 yes | no | yes | yes
7649 Arguments :
7650 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007651 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7652 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007653
7654 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7655 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007656 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007657 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7658 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7659 forwarded to this server.
7660
7661 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7662 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7663 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007664 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007665 a single "listen" section.
7666
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007667 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7668 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7669 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7670
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007671 Example :
7672 listen tse-farm
7673 bind :3389
7674 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7675 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7676 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7677 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7678 persist rdp-cookie
7679 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007680 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007681 balance rdp-cookie
7682 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7683 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7684
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007685 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7686 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007687
7688
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007689rate-limit sessions <rate>
7690 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7692 yes | yes | yes | no
7693 Arguments :
7694 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7695 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7696
7697 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7698 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7699 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7700 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7701 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7702 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7703
7704 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7705 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7706 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7707 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7708
7709 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7710 listen smtp
7711 mode tcp
7712 bind :25
7713 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007714 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007715
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007716 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7717 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7718 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007719
7720 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7721
7722
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007723redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7724redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7725redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007726 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7728 no | yes | yes | yes
7729
7730 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007731 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007732
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007733 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007734 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007735 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7736 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7737 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007738
7739 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7740 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7741 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7742 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7743 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007744 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7745 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7746 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7747 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007748
7749 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7750 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7751 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7752 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7753 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7754 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007755 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007756 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007757 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7758 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7759 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007760
7761 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007762 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7763 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7764 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007765 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007766 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7767 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7768 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7769 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007770
7771 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007772 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007773
7774 - "drop-query"
7775 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7776 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7777 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7778 with a location-type redirect.
7779
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007780 - "append-slash"
7781 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7782 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7783 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7784 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7785
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007786 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7787 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7788 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7789 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7790 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7791 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7792 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7793
7794 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7795 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7796 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7797 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7798 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7799 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7800 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007801
7802 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7803 acl clear dst_port 80
7804 acl secure dst_port 8080
7805 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007806 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007807 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007808 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7809
7810 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007811 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7812 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7813 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007814 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007815
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007816 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7817 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7818 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7819
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007820 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007821 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007822
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007823 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007824 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7825 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7826 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007828 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007829
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007830
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007831retries <value>
7832 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7833 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7834 yes | no | yes | yes
7835 Arguments :
7836 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7837 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7838 default value is 3.
7839
7840 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7841 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7842 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7843
7844 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007845 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7846 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007847
7848 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7849 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7850
7851 See also : "option redispatch"
7852
7853
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007854retry-on [list of keywords]
7855 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7856 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7857 yes | no | yes | yes
7858 Arguments :
7859 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7860 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7861 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7862 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7863
7864 none never retry
7865
7866 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7867 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7868
7869 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7870 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7871 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7872 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7873 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7874 processing the request.
7875
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007876 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7877 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7878 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7879 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7880 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7881 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7882 overflow attack for example).
7883
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007884 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7885 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7886 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7887 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7888 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7889 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7890 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7891 amplify denial of service attacks.
7892
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007893 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7894 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7895 considered to be safe to retry.
7896
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007897 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7898 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7899 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7900 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7901
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007902 all-retryable-errors
7903 retry request for any error that are considered
7904 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7905 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7906 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7907
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007908 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7909 not cumulative.
7910
7911 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7912 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7913 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7914 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7915
7916 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7917 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7918 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7919 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7920 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7921 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7922 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7923 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7924 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7925 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7926 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7927 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7928
7929 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7930 should not use this directive.
7931
7932 The default is "conn-failure".
7933
7934 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7935
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007936server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007937 Declare a server in a backend
7938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7939 no | no | yes | yes
7940 Arguments :
7941 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007942 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007943 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007944
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007945 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7946 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7947 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7948 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007949 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7950 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7951 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7952 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7953 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007954 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7955 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7956 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7957 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7958 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7959 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7960 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007961 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007962 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7963 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7964 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7965 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7966 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7967 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007968 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7969 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007970 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7971 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007972
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007973 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007974 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7975 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7976 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7977 adding this value to the client's port.
7978
7979 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7980 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007981 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007982
7983 Examples :
7984 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7985 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007986 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007987 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7988 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7989 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007990
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007991 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7992 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7993 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7994 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7995 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7996
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007997 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7998 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007999
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008000server-state-file-name [<file>]
8001 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8002 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8003 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8004 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8005 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8006 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8007
8008 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8009 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8010
8011 global
8012 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8013
8014 backend bk
8015 load-server-state-from-file
8016
8017 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8018 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008019
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008020server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8021 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8022 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8024 no | no | yes | yes
8025
8026 Arguments:
8027 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8028
8029 <num | range>
8030 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8031 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8032 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8033 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8034
8035 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8036
8037 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8038
8039 <params*>
8040 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8041 keyword.
8042
8043 Examples:
8044 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8045 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8046 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8047
8048 # or
8049 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8050
8051 # would be equivalent to:
8052 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8053 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8054 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8055
8056
8057
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008058source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008059source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008060source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008061 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8063 yes | no | yes | yes
8064 Arguments :
8065 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8066 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008067
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008068 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008069 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8070 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8071 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8072 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8073 supported prefixes are :
8074 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8075 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8076 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008077 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008078 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8079 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008080
8081 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8082 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008083 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8084 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8085 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008086
8087 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8088 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8089 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8090 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8091 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8092 <addr>.
8093
8094 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8095 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8096 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8097 port.
8098
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008099 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8100 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8101 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8102 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008103 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008104 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8105 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8106 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8107 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8108 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8109 HTTP header.
8110
8111 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8112 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008113 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008114 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8115 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8116 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8117 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8118 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8119 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8120 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8121
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008122 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8123 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8124 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8125 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8126 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8127 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8128
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008129 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8130 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8131 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8132 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8133
8134 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8135 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8136 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8137 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8138 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8139 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8140
8141 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8142 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8143 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8144 there are two methods :
8145
8146 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8147 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8148 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8149 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8150 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8151 of the client ranges may be used.
8152
8153 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8154 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8155 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8156 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8157 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8158 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8159 same session.
8160
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008161 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8162 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8163 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008164 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008165
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008166 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8167
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008168 Examples :
8169 backend private
8170 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8171 source 192.168.1.200
8172
8173 backend transparent_ssl1
8174 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8175 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8176
8177 backend transparent_ssl2
8178 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8179 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8180 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8181
8182 backend transparent_ssl3
8183 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8184 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8185 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8186
8187 backend transparent_smtp
8188 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8189 # with Tproxy version 4.
8190 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8191
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008192 backend transparent_http
8193 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8194 # proxy.
8195 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008197 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008198 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8199
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008200
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008201stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8202 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008204 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008205
8206 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8207 matched.
8208
8209 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8210 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8211
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008212 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8213 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008214 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008215
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008216 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8217 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8218 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8219 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008220
8221 Example :
8222 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8223 backend stats_localhost
8224 stats enable
8225 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8226
8227 Example :
8228 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8229 backend stats_auth
8230 stats enable
8231 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8232 stats admin if TRUE
8233
8234 Example :
8235 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8236 userlist stats-auth
8237 group admin users admin
8238 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8239 group readonly users haproxy
8240 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8241
8242 backend stats_auth
8243 stats enable
8244 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8245 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8246 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8247 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8248
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008249 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8250 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8251 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008252
8253
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008254stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8255 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008257 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008258 Arguments :
8259 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8260
8261 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8262
8263 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8264 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8265 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8266 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8267 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8268 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8269
8270 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8271 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8272 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008273 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008274
8275 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8276 report using "stats scope".
8277
8278 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8279 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8280 unobvious parameters.
8281
8282 Example :
8283 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8284 backend public_www
8285 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8286 stats enable
8287 stats hide-version
8288 stats scope .
8289 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008290 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008291 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8292 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8293
8294 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8295 backend private_monitoring
8296 stats enable
8297 stats uri /admin?stats
8298 stats refresh 5s
8299
8300 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8301
8302
8303stats enable
8304 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008306 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008307 Arguments : none
8308
8309 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8310 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8311 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8312 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8313 - stats auth : no authentication
8314 - stats scope : no restriction
8315
8316 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8317 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8318 unobvious parameters.
8319
8320 Example :
8321 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8322 backend public_www
8323 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8324 stats enable
8325 stats hide-version
8326 stats scope .
8327 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008328 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008329 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8330 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8331
8332 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8333 backend private_monitoring
8334 stats enable
8335 stats uri /admin?stats
8336 stats refresh 5s
8337
8338 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8339
8340
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008341stats hide-version
8342 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008344 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008345 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008346
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008347 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8348 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8349 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8350 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8351 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8352 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008354 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8355 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8356 unobvious parameters.
8357
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008358 Example :
8359 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8360 backend public_www
8361 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008362 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008363 stats hide-version
8364 stats scope .
8365 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008366 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008367 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8368 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008369
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008370 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8371 backend private_monitoring
8372 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008373 stats uri /admin?stats
8374 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008375
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008376 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008377
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008378
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008379stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8380 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8381 Access control for statistics
8382
8383 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8384 no | no | yes | yes
8385
8386 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8387 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8388 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8389 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8390 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8391 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8392
8393 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8394 instance.
8395
8396 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8397 about ACL usage.
8398
8399
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008400stats realm <realm>
8401 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008403 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008404 Arguments :
8405 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8406 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8407 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8408
8409 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8410 using a backslash ('\').
8411
8412 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8413 only related to authentication.
8414
8415 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8416 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8417 unobvious parameters.
8418
8419 Example :
8420 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8421 backend public_www
8422 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8423 stats enable
8424 stats hide-version
8425 stats scope .
8426 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008427 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008428 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8429 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8430
8431 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8432 backend private_monitoring
8433 stats enable
8434 stats uri /admin?stats
8435 stats refresh 5s
8436
8437 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8438
8439
8440stats refresh <delay>
8441 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008443 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008444 Arguments :
8445 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8446 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8447 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8448 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8449 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8450 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8451
8452 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8453 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8454 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8455 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8456
8457 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8458 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8459 unobvious parameters.
8460
8461 Example :
8462 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8463 backend public_www
8464 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8465 stats enable
8466 stats hide-version
8467 stats scope .
8468 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008469 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008470 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8471 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8472
8473 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8474 backend private_monitoring
8475 stats enable
8476 stats uri /admin?stats
8477 stats refresh 5s
8478
8479 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8480
8481
8482stats scope { <name> | "." }
8483 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008485 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008486 Arguments :
8487 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8488 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8489 section in which the statement appears.
8490
8491 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8492 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8493 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8494 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8495 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8496 exists.
8497
8498 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8499 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8500 unobvious parameters.
8501
8502 Example :
8503 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8504 backend public_www
8505 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8506 stats enable
8507 stats hide-version
8508 stats scope .
8509 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008510 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008511 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8512 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8513
8514 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8515 backend private_monitoring
8516 stats enable
8517 stats uri /admin?stats
8518 stats refresh 5s
8519
8520 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8521
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008522
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008523stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008524 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008526 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008527
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008528 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008529 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8530
8531 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8532 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8533
8534 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8535 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008536 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008537
8538 Example :
8539 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8540 backend private_monitoring
8541 stats enable
8542 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8543 stats uri /admin?stats
8544 stats refresh 5s
8545
8546 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8547 global section.
8548
8549
8550stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008551 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8553 yes | yes | yes | yes
8554 Arguments : none
8555
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008556 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008557 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8558 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8559 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8560 - IP (socket, server)
8561 - cookie (backend, server)
8562
8563 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8564 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008565 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008566
8567 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8568
8569
8570stats show-node [ <name> ]
8571 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008573 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008574 Arguments:
8575 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8576 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8577
8578 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8579 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008580 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008581
8582 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8583 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8584 unobvious parameters.
8585
8586 Example:
8587 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8588 backend private_monitoring
8589 stats enable
8590 stats show-node Europe-1
8591 stats uri /admin?stats
8592 stats refresh 5s
8593
8594 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8595 section.
8596
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008597
8598stats uri <prefix>
8599 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008601 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008602 Arguments :
8603 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8604 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8605 query string.
8606
8607 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8608 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8609 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8610 possible to reach it in the application.
8611
8612 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008613 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008614 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8615 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8616 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8617 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8618
8619 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8620 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8621 an address or a port to statistics only.
8622
8623 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8624 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8625 unobvious parameters.
8626
8627 Example :
8628 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8629 backend public_www
8630 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8631 stats enable
8632 stats hide-version
8633 stats scope .
8634 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008635 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008636 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8637 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8638
8639 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8640 backend private_monitoring
8641 stats enable
8642 stats uri /admin?stats
8643 stats refresh 5s
8644
8645 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8646
8647
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008648stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8649 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008651 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008652
8653 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008654 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008655 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008656 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008657 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8658
8659 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8660 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8661 the "stick-table" statement.
8662
8663 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8664 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8665 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8666 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8667 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8668
8669 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8670 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8671 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8672 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8673 transformation rules.
8674
8675 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8676 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8677 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8678 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8679 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8680 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8681 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8682
8683 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8684 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8685 ACL based conditions.
8686
8687 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8688 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8689 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8690 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8691
8692 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8693 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8694 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8695 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8696
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008697 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8698 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008699 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008700
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008701 Example :
8702 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8703 # last 30 minutes
8704 backend pop
8705 mode tcp
8706 balance roundrobin
8707 stick store-request src
8708 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8709 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8710 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8711
8712 backend smtp
8713 mode tcp
8714 balance roundrobin
8715 stick match src table pop
8716 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8717 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8718
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008719 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008720 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008721
8722
8723stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8724 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8726 no | no | yes | yes
8727
8728 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8729 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8730 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8731 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8732
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008733 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8734 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008735 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008736
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008737 Examples :
8738 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008739 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008740
8741 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8742 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8743 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8744
8745
8746 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8747 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8748 backend http
8749 mode http
8750 balance roundrobin
8751 stick on src table https
8752 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8753 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8754 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8755
8756 backend https
8757 mode tcp
8758 balance roundrobin
8759 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8760 stick on src
8761 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8762 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8763
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008764 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008765
8766
8767stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8768 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8770 no | no | yes | yes
8771
8772 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008773 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008774 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008775 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008776 server is selected.
8777
8778 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8779 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8780 the "stick-table" statement.
8781
8782 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8783 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8784 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8785 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8786 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8787 address.
8788
8789 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8790 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8791 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8792 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8793 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8794 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8795 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8796 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8797 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8798 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8799
8800 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8801 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8802 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8803 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8804 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8805 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8806 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8807
8808 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8809 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8810 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8811 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8812
8813 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8814 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8815 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8816 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8817 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8818 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008819 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8820 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8821 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8822 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8823 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8824 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008825
8826 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8827 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8828 the request.
8829
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008830 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8831 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008832 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008833
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008834 Example :
8835 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8836 # last 30 minutes
8837 backend pop
8838 mode tcp
8839 balance roundrobin
8840 stick store-request src
8841 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8842 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8843 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8844
8845 backend smtp
8846 mode tcp
8847 balance roundrobin
8848 stick match src table pop
8849 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8850 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8851
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008852 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008853 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008854
8855
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008856stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008857 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8858 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008859 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008861 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008862
8863 Arguments :
8864 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8865 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8866 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8867 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8868
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008869 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8870 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8871 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8872 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8873
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008874 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8875 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8876 instance.
8877
8878 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8879 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8880 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8881 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8882 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8883 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008884 to 32 characters.
8885
8886 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8887 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8888 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008889 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008890 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8891 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008892
8893 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008894 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8895 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008896 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8897 increase.
8898
8899 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008900 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8901 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8902 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008903
8904 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8905 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8906 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8907 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008908 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008909 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8910 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8911 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8912 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8913 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8914 parameter (see below).
8915
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008916 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8917 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8918 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8919 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8920 soft restart.
8921
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008922 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8923 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008924
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008925 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8926 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8927 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8928 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008929 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008930 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008931 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8932 if not expiration delay is specified.
8933
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008934 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8935 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8936 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8937 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008938 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8939 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8940 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8941 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8942 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8943 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8944 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8945 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8946 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8947 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8948 types and their arguments.
8949
8950 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8951 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8952 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8953 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8954
8955 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8956 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8957 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008958 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008959
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008960 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8961 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8962 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008963 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008964 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008965 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008966
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008967 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8968 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8969 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8970 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8971
8972 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8973 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8974 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8975 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8976 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8977 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8978
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008979 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8980 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8981 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8982 they were received.
8983
8984 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8985 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8986 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8987 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8988 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8989
8990 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8991 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8992 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8993 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8994 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8995
8996 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8997 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8998 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8999
9000 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9001 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9002 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9003 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9004 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9005
9006 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9007 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9008 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9009 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9010 the client side.
9011
9012 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9013 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9014 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9015 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9016 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9017 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9018 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9019
9020 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9021 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9022 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9023 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9024 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9025 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009026 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009027
9028 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9029 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9030 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9031 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9032 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9033 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9034
9035 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009036 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009037 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9038 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9039
9040 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9041 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9042 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9043 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9044 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9045 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9046 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9047 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9048 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9049 recommended for better fairness.
9050
9051 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009052 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009053 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9054 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9055
9056 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9057 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9058 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9059 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9060 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9061 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9062 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9063 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9064 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9065 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009066
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009067 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9068 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009069 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9070 reference it.
9071
9072 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9073 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009074 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9075 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9076 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009077
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009078 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9079 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9080 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9081 something that can be ignored.
9082
9083 Example:
9084 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9085 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9086 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9087 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9088
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009089 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009090 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009091
9092
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009093stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009094 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9096 no | no | yes | yes
9097
9098 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009099 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009100 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009101 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009102 server is selected.
9103
9104 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9105 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9106 the "stick-table" statement.
9107
9108 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9109 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9110 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9111 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9112
9113 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9114 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9115 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9116 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9117 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9118 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009119 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009120 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9121 rules.
9122
9123 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9124 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9125 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9126 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9127 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9128 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9129 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9130
9131 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9132 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9133 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9134 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9135
9136 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9137 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9138 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9139 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9140 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9141 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009142 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9143 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9144 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9145 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9146 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9147 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9148 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9149 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9150 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009151
9152 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9153
9154 Example :
9155 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9156 backend https
9157 mode tcp
9158 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009159 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009160 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009161
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009162 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9163 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9164
9165 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9166 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9167 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9168
9169 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9170 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009171
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009172 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9173 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9174 # at offset 44.
9175
9176 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9177 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9178
9179 # Learn on response if server hello.
9180 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009181
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009182 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9183 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9184
9185 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9186 extraction.
9187
9188
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009189tcp-check connect [params*]
9190 Opens a new connection
9191 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9192 no | no | yes | yes
9193
9194 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9195 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9196 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9197
9198 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9199 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9200 of the sequence.
9201
9202 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9203 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9204 do.
9205
9206 Parameters :
9207 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9208 use the TCP connection.
9209
9210 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9211 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9212 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9213
9214 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9215
9216 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9217
9218 Examples:
9219 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9220 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9221 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9222 option tcp-check
9223 tcp-check connect
9224 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9225 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9226 tcp-check send \r\n
9227 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9228 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9229 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9230 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9231 tcp-check send \r\n
9232 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9233 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9234
9235 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9236 option tcp-check
9237 tcp-check connect port 110
9238 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9239 tcp-check connect port 143
9240 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9241 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9242
9243 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9244
9245
9246tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009247 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009248 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9249 no | no | yes | yes
9250
9251 Arguments :
9252 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9253 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9254 binary.
9255 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9256 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9257 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9258
9259 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9260 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9261 with the usual backslash ('\').
9262 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009263 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009264 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9265 used upper or lower case.
9266
9267
9268 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9269
9270 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9271 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9272 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9273 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9274 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9275 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9276 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9277 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9278
9279 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9280 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9281 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9282 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9283 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9284 expression.
9285
9286 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9287 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9288 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9289 this exact hexadecimal string.
9290 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9291
9292 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9293 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9294 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9295 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9296 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9297 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9298 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9299 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9300 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9301 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9302 the null character.
9303
9304 Examples :
9305 # perform a POP check
9306 option tcp-check
9307 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9308
9309 # perform an IMAP check
9310 option tcp-check
9311 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9312
9313 # look for the redis master server
9314 option tcp-check
9315 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009316 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009317 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9318 tcp-check expect string role:master
9319 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9320 tcp-check expect string +OK
9321
9322
9323 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9324 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9325
9326
9327tcp-check send <data>
9328 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9329 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9330 no | no | yes | yes
9331
9332 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9333 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9334
9335 Examples :
9336 # look for the redis master server
9337 option tcp-check
9338 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9339 tcp-check expect string role:master
9340
9341 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9342 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9343
9344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009345tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9346 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009347 tcp health check
9348 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9349 no | no | yes | yes
9350
9351 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9352 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009353 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009354 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9355 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9356 hexadecimal string.
9357 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9358
9359 Examples :
9360 # redis check in binary
9361 option tcp-check
9362 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9363 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9364
9365
9366 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9367 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9368
9369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009370tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9371 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9373 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009374 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009375 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9376 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009377
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009378 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009379
9380 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9381 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009382 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9383 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9384 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9385 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9386 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9387 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009388
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009389 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9390 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9391 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9392 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009393
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009394 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009395 - accept :
9396 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9397 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9398 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009399
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009400 - reject :
9401 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9402 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9403 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9404 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9405 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9406 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9407 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9408 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9409 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9410 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9411 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009412 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009413
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009414 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9415 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9416 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9417 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9418 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9419 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9420 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9421 hosts.
9422
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009423 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9424 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9425 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9426 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9427 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9428 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9429 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9430 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9431
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009432 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9433 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9434 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9435 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9436 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9437 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9438 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9439 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9440 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009441 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9442 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009443
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009444 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009445 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009446 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9447 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9448 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009449 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009450 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9451 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9452 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9453 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9454 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9455 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9456 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9457 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009459 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009460 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009461 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009462 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009463 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9464 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9465 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009466
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009467 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9468 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9469 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9470 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009471
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009472 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9473 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9474 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9475 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9476 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009477 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9478 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9479 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9480 layer7 information is extracted.
9481
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009482 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9483 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9484 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9485 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9486 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009487
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009488 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9489 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9490 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9491 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9492
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009493 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9494 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9495 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9496 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9497
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009498 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9499 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9500 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9501 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9502 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009503
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009504 - set-src <expr> :
9505 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9506 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9507 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009508 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009509
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009510 Arguments:
9511 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9512 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009513
9514 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009515 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9516
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009517 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9518 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009519
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009520 - set-src-port <expr> :
9521 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9522 expression.
9523
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009524 Arguments:
9525 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9526 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009527
9528 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009529 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9530
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009531 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9532 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9533 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009534
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009535 - set-dst <expr> :
9536 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9537 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9538 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9539 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9540 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9541
9542 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9543 followed by some converters.
9544
9545 Example:
9546
9547 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9548 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9549
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009550 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9551 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9552
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009553 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9554 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9555 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9556 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9557
9558
9559 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9560 followed by some converters.
9561
9562 Example:
9563
9564 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9565
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009566 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9567 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9568 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9569
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009570 - "silent-drop" :
9571 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009572 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009573 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9574 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9575 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9576 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9577 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009578 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9579 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009580 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9581 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009582 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009583 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9584 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9585 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9586 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9587
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009588 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9589 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9590 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009591
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009592 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9593 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9594 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009595
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009596 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009597 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009598 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009599
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009600 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9601 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9602 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009603
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009604 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009605 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9606 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009607
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009608 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9609
9610 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9611
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009612 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9613
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009614 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009615
9616
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009617tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9618 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009620 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009621 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009622 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9623 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009624
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009625 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009626
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009627 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009628 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9629 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9630 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9631 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009632
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009633 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9634 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9635 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9636 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009637 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9638 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9639 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9640 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9641 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9642 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009643 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009644 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009645
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009646 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9647 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9648 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9649 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009650
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009651 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009652 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009653 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009654 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9655 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009656 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009657 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009658 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009659 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009660 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009661 - set-dst <expr>
9662 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009663 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009664 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009665 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009666 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009667 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009668
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009669 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9670 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009671 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9672 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009673
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009674 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9675 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9676 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9677 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9678 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9679 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009680
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009681 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009682 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9683 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009684
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009685 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009686 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9687 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9688 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9689 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009690 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9691 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9692 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009693
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009694 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009695 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9696 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9697 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009698
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009699 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9700 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9701
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009702 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009703 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9704 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009705
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009706 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9707 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009708 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009709 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9710 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009711 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009712 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009713 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009714 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9715 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009716 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009717 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9718 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009719
9720 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9721 followed by some converters.
9722
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009723 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9724 <var-name>.
9725
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009726 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9727 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9728 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9729 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9730 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9731
9732 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9733 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9734 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9735 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9736 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9737 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9738 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9739 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9740 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9741 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9742 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9743
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009744 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9745 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9746 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9747 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9748 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9749
9750 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9751
9752 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9753
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009754 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9755 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9756 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9757 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9758 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9759 evaluated.
9760
9761 Example:
9762 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9763
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009764 Example:
9765
9766 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009767 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009768
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009769 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009770 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9771 # and reject everything else.
9772 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9773 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009774 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009775 tcp-request content reject
9776
9777 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009778 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9779 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9780 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009781 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009782
9783 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9784 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9785 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009786 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009787 tcp-request content reject
9788
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009789 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009790 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009791 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009792 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009793 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9794 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009795
9796 Example:
9797 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9798 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009799 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009800
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009801 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009802 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009803
9804 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009805 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009806 # protecting all our sites
9807 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009808 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9809 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009810 ...
9811 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9812
9813 backend http_dynamic
9814 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009815 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009816 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009817 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009818 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009819 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009820 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009822 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009823
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009824 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9825 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009826
9827
9828tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9829 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009831 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009832 Arguments :
9833 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9834 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9835 as explained at the top of this document.
9836
9837 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9838 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9839 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9840 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9841 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9842
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009843 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9844 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9845 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9846 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9847
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009848 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9849 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009850 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009851 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009852 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9853 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9854 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9855 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009856
9857 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9858 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9859 it pass through unaffected.
9860
9861 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9862 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9863 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009864 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009865 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9866 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009867 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9868 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9869 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009870
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009871 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009872 "timeout client".
9873
9874
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009875tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9876 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9878 no | no | yes | yes
9879 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009880 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9881 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009882
9883 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9884
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009885 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009886 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9887 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009888 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9889 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009890
9891 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9892
9893 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9894 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9895 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9896 inserted.
9897
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009898 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009899 - accept :
9900 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9901 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9902 the rules evaluation.
9903
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009904 - close :
9905 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9906 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9907 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9908 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9909 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9910 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009911 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009912 protocols.
9913
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009914 - reject :
9915 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9916 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009917 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009918
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009919 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9920 Sets a variable.
9921
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009922 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9923 Unsets a variable.
9924
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009925 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9926 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9927 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9928 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9929
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009930 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9931 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9932 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9933 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9934
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009935 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
9936 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9937 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9938 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9939 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009940
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009941 - "silent-drop" :
9942 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009943 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009944 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9945 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9946 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9947 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9948 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009949 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9950 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009951 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9952 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009953 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009954 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9955 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9956 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9957 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9958
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009959 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9960 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9961
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009962 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9963 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9964 for changing the default action to a reject.
9965
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009966 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9967 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9968 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9969 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009970 period.
9971
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009972 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9973 declared inline.
9974
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009975 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9976 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009977 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009978 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9979 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009980 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009981 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009982 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009983 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9984 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009985 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009986 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9987 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009988
9989 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9990 followed by some converters.
9991
9992 Example:
9993
9994 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9995
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009996 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9997 <var-name>.
9998
9999 Example:
10000
10001 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10002
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010003 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10004 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10005 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10006 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10007 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10008
10009 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10010
10011 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10012
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010013 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10014
10015 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10016
10017
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010018tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10019 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10021 no | yes | yes | no
10022 Arguments :
10023 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10024 below.
10025
10026 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10027
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010028 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010029 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10030 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10031 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10032 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10033 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10034 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10035 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010036 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010037 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10038 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10039 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10040 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10041 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10042 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10043 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10044 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10045 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10046 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10047 instead.
10048
10049 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10050 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10051 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10052 rules which may be inserted.
10053
10054 Several types of actions are supported :
10055 - accept : the request is accepted
10056 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10057 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10058 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010059 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010060 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010061 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010062 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010063 - silent-drop
10064
10065 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10066 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10067 sections for a complete description.
10068
10069 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10070 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10071 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10072
10073 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10074 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10075 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10076 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10077 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10078
10079 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10080 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10081
10082 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10083 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10084 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10085
10086 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10087 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10088 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10089
10090 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10091 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10092 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10093
10094 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10095 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10096 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10097
10098 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10099
10100 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10101
10102
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010103tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10104 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10106 no | no | yes | yes
10107 Arguments :
10108 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10109 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10110 as explained at the top of this document.
10111
10112 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10113
10114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010115timeout check <timeout>
10116 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10117 established.
10118
10119 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10120 yes | no | yes | yes
10121 Arguments:
10122 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10123 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10124 as explained at the top of this document.
10125
10126 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10127 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010128 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010129 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010130 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10131 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10132 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010133
10134 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10135 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10136
10137 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10138 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010139 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010140
10141 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10142 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10143 forget about it.
10144
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010145 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10146 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010147
10148
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010149timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010150 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10152 yes | yes | yes | no
10153 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010154 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010155 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10156 as explained at the top of this document.
10157
10158 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10159 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10160 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010161 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10162 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10163 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10164 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010165 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10166 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10167 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010168 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010169 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010170 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10171 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010172 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10173 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010174
10175 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10176 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10177 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10178 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010179 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010180 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10181
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010182 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010183
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010184 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010185
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010186
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010187timeout client-fin <timeout>
10188 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10190 yes | yes | yes | no
10191 Arguments :
10192 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10193 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10194 as explained at the top of this document.
10195
10196 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10197 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10198 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10199 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10200 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10201 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10202 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010203 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10204 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10205 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010206
10207 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10208 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10209 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10210
10211 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10212
10213
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010214timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010215 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10217 yes | no | yes | yes
10218 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010219 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010220 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10221 as explained at the top of this document.
10222
10223 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010224 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010225 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010226 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010227 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10228 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010229
10230 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10231 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10232 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10233 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010234 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010235 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10236
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010237 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010238
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010239
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010240timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10241 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10243 yes | yes | yes | yes
10244 Arguments :
10245 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10246 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10247 as explained at the top of this document.
10248
10249 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10250 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10251 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10252 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10253 once the request has started to present itself.
10254
10255 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10256 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10257 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10258 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10259 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10260
10261 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10262 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10263 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10264 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10265
10266 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10267 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010268 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010269 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10270 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010271 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010272
10273 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10274 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10275 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10276 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010278 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10279 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010280 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10281
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010282 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10283
10284
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010285timeout http-request <timeout>
10286 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010288 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010289 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010290 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010291 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10292 as explained at the top of this document.
10293
10294 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10295 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10296 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10297 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10298 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10299 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10300 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010301 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10302 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10303 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10304 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010305 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010306 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10307 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010308
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010309 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10310 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10311 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10312 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10313 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010314 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010315
10316 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10317 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010318 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010319 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10320 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10321
10322 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010323 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10324 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10325 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010326
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010327 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010328 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010329
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010330
10331timeout queue <timeout>
10332 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10334 yes | no | yes | yes
10335 Arguments :
10336 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10337 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10338 as explained at the top of this document.
10339
10340 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10341 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10342 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10343 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10344 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10345
10346 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10347 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10348 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10349 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10350
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010351 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010352
10353
10354timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010355 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10357 yes | no | yes | yes
10358 Arguments :
10359 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10360 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10361 as explained at the top of this document.
10362
10363 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10364 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10365 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10366 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10367 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10368 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10369 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10370
10371 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10372 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10373 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10374 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10375 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010376 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010377 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010378 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10379 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010380 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10381 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010382
10383 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10384 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10385 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10386 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010387 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010388 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10389
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010390 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010391
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010392
10393timeout server-fin <timeout>
10394 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10396 yes | no | yes | yes
10397 Arguments :
10398 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10399 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10400 as explained at the top of this document.
10401
10402 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10403 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10404 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10405 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10406 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10407 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10408 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10409 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10410 situations, it should not be needed.
10411
10412 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10413 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10414 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10415
10416 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10417
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010418
10419timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010420 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10422 yes | yes | yes | yes
10423 Arguments :
10424 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10425 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10426 as explained at the top of this document.
10427
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010428 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10429 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10430 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010431
10432 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10433 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10434 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10435 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010436 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010437
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010438 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010439
10440
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010441timeout tunnel <timeout>
10442 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10444 yes | no | yes | yes
10445 Arguments :
10446 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10447 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10448 as explained at the top of this document.
10449
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010450 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010451 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10452 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10453 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010454 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10455 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010456 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10457 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10458 specified.
10459
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010460 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10461 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10462 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10463 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10464 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10465 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10466 state.
10467
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010468 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10469 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10470 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10471 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010472 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010473
10474 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10475 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10476 forget about it.
10477
10478 Example :
10479 defaults http
10480 option http-server-close
10481 timeout connect 5s
10482 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010483 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010484 timeout server 30s
10485 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10486
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010487 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010488
10489
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010490transparent (deprecated)
10491 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010493 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010494 Arguments : none
10495
10496 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10497 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10498 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10499 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10500 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10501 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10502 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10503 appropriate server.
10504
10505 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10506
10507 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10508 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10509
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010510 See also: "option transparent"
10511
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010512unique-id-format <string>
10513 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10515 yes | yes | yes | no
10516 Arguments :
10517 <string> is a log-format string.
10518
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010519 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10520 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10521 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10522 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010523
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010524 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10525 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10526 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10527 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10528 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10529 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10530 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10531 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010532
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010533 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10534 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010535
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010536 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010537
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010538 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010539
10540 will generate:
10541
10542 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10543
10544 See also: "unique-id-header"
10545
10546unique-id-header <name>
10547 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10549 yes | yes | yes | no
10550 Arguments :
10551 <name> is the name of the header.
10552
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010553 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10554 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010555
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010556 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010557
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010558 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010559 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10560
10561 will generate:
10562
10563 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10564
10565 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010566
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010567use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010568 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10570 no | yes | yes | no
10571 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010572 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10573 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010574
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010575 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10576 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010577
10578 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10579 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10580 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010581 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010582 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010583 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10584 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010585
10586 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10587 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10588 assign the backend.
10589
10590 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10591 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10592 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10593 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10594 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10595 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10596
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010597 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010598 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010599 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10600 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10601 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10602
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010603 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10604 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10605 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10606 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10607 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10608 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10609 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10610 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10611 cannot be forced from the request.
10612
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010613 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010614 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10615 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10616
10617 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10618 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010619
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010620use-fcgi-app <name>
10621 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10623 no | no | yes | yes
10624 Arguments :
10625 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10626
10627 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010628
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010629use-server <server> if <condition>
10630use-server <server> unless <condition>
10631 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10633 no | no | yes | yes
10634 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010635 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010636
10637 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10638
10639 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10640 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10641 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10642
10643 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10644 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10645 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10646 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10647 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10648 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10649 matches will assign the server.
10650
10651 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10652 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10653 with the next rules until one matches.
10654
10655 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10656 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10657 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10658 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10659
10660 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10661 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10662 stripped.
10663
10664 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10665 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10666 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10667 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10668
10669 Example :
10670 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10671 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10672 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10673 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10674 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10675 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010676 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010677 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10678 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10679
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010680 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010681
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010682
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100106835. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010684--------------------------
10685
10686The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10687depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10688settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10689written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10690described in this section.
10691
10692
106935.1. Bind options
10694-----------------
10695
10696The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10697as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10698no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10699parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10700while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10701provided immediately after the setting name.
10702
10703The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10704
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010705accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10706 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10707 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10708 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10709 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10710 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10711 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10712 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10713 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10714 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010715 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10716 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10717 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010718
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010719accept-proxy
10720 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010721 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10722 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010723 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10724 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10725 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10726 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010727 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010728 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10729 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010730 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10731 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010732
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010733allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010734 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010735 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010736 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010737 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10738 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010739
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010740alpn <protocols>
10741 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10742 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10743 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010744 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010745 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010746 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10747 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10748 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10749 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10750 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10751 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10752 preference, like below :
10753
10754 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010755
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010756backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010757 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010758 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10759
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010760curves <curves>
10761 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10762 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10763 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10764 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10765 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10766 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10767
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010768ecdhe <named curve>
10769 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010770 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10771 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010772
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010773ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010774 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10775 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10776 client's certificate.
10777
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010778ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10779 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10780 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10781 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10782 error is ignored.
10783
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010784ca-sign-file <cafile>
10785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10786 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10787 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10788 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10789 'generate-certificates' for details.
10790
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010791ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10793 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10794 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10795 'generate-certificates' for details.
10796
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010797ciphers <ciphers>
10798 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10799 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010800 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010801 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010802 information and recommendations see e.g.
10803 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10804 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10805 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10806
10807ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10809 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10810 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10811 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010812 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10813 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010814
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010815crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010816 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10817 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10818 to verify client's certificate.
10819
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010820crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10822 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10823 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10824 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10825 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10826 file.
10827
10828 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10829 are loaded.
10830
10831 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010832 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010833 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10834 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10835 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10836 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010837 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10838 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010839 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010840
10841 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10842 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10843 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10844 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010845 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10846 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010847
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010848 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010849
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010850 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010851 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010852 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10853 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010854 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10855 clients).
10856
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010857 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10858 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10859 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10860 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10861 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10862 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10863 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10864 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10865 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10866 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10867 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10868 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10869 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10870
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010871 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10872 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10873 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10874 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10875 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10876
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010877 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10878 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10879 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10880 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010881
10882 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10883 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10884 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10885 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10886 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10887 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10888 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10889 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10890 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10891
10892 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10893
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010894 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010895 a cert bundle.
10896
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010897 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010898 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10899 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10900 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10901 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10902 provide multi-cert support.
10903
10904 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10905
10906 Filename | CN | SAN
10907 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10908 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010909 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010910 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10911 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10912
10913 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10914 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10915 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10916 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010917 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10918 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10919 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010920
10921 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10922 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10923
10924 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10925 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10926 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10927
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010928crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010929 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010930 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010931 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010932 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010933
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010934crt-list <file>
10935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010936 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10937 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010938
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010939 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10940
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010941 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10942 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010943 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010944 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010945
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010946 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10947 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10948 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10949 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10950 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10951 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10952 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10953 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010954
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010955 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010956 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010957 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10958 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10959 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010960
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010961 crt-list file example:
10962 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010963 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010964 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010965 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010966
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010967defer-accept
10968 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10969 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10970 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010971 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010972 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10973 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10974 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10975 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10976 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10977 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10978 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10979
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010980expose-fd listeners
10981 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10982 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010983 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10984 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010985 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010986
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010987force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010988 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010989 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010990 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010991 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010992
10993force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010994 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010995 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010996 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010997
10998force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010999 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011000 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011001 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011002
11003force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011004 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011005 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011006 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011007
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011008force-tlsv13
11009 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11010 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011011 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011012
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011013generate-certificates
11014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11015 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11016 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11017 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11018 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11019 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11020 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11021 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11022 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11023 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11024 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11025
11026 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11027 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011028 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011029 certificate is used many times.
11030
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011031gid <gid>
11032 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11033 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11034 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11035 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11036 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11037
11038group <group>
11039 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11040 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11041 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11042 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11043 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11044
11045id <id>
11046 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11047 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11048 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11049 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11050
11051interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011052 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11053 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11054 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11055 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11056 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11057 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011058 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11059 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11060 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11061 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11062 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11063 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011064
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011065level <level>
11066 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11067 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11068 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011069 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011070 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11071 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11072 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011073 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011074 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011075 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011076 all counters).
11077
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011078severity-output <format>
11079 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11080 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11081 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11082 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11083 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11084 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11085 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11086 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11087 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11088 rfc5424 convention.
11089
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011090maxconn <maxconn>
11091 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11092 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11093 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11094 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11095 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11096 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11097 eat all memory.
11098
11099mode <mode>
11100 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11101 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11102 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11103 UNIX sockets.
11104
11105mss <maxseg>
11106 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11107 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11108 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11109 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11110 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11111 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11112 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11113 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11114 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11115 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11116 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11117
11118name <name>
11119 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11120 page.
11121
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011122namespace <name>
11123 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11124 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11125 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11126 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11127
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011128nice <nice>
11129 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11130 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11131 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11132 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11133 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11134 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11135 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11136 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11137 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11138 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11139 one for an RDP socket.
11140
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011141no-ca-names
11142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11143 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11144
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011145no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011147 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011148 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011149 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011150 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11151 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011152
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011153no-tls-tickets
11154 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11155 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11156 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011157 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11158 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011159
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011160no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011162 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011163 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011164 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011165 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11166 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011167
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011168no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011170 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011171 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011172 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011173 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11174 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011175
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011176no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011178 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011179 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011180 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011181 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11182 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011183
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011184no-tlsv13
11185 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11186 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11187 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11188 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011189 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11190 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011191
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011192npn <protocols>
11193 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11194 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11195 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011196 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011197 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011198 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11199 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11200 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11201 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11202 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011203
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011204prefer-client-ciphers
11205 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11206 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11207 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011208 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11209 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11210 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011211
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011212process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011213 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011214 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011215 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011216 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11217 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11218 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11219 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011220 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011221 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11222 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11223 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11224 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11225 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011226
11227 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11228
11229 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11230 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11231 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11232 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11233 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11234 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11235 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11236 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011237
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011238proto <name>
11239 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11240 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11241 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11242 in haproxy -vv.
11243 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11244 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011245 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011246 h2" on the bind line.
11247
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011248ssl
11249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011250 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011251 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11252 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011253 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11254 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011255
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011256ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11257 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11258 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11259 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11260
11261ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11262 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11263 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11264 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11265
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011266strict-sni
11267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11268 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11269 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11270 See the "crt" option for more information.
11271
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011272tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011273 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011274 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11275 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011276 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011277 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11278 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11279 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11280 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11281 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11282 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11283 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11284
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011285tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011286 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011287 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11288 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11289 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11290 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11291 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11292 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11293 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011294 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11295 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11296 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011297
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011298tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11299 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011300 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11301 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11302 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11303 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11304 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11305 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11306 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11307 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11308 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11309 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011310 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11311 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11312
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011313transparent
11314 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11315 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11316 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11317 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11318 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11319 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11320 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11321 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11322 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11323 so check for support with your vendor.
11324
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011325v4v6
11326 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11327 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11328 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11329 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011330 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011331
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011332v6only
11333 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11334 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11335 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011336 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11337 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011338
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011339uid <uid>
11340 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11341 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11342 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11343 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11344 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11345
11346user <user>
11347 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11348 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11349 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11350 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11351 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11352
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011353verify [none|optional|required]
11354 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11355 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11356 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11357 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11358 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011359 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11360 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11361 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11362 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011363
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200113645.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011365------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011367The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11368which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11369arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11370settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11371after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11372Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11373address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011375 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011376 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011377
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011378Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11379keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011381The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011382
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011383addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011384 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011385 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11386 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11387 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11388 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11389 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011390
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011391agent-check
11392 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011393 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011394 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11395 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11396 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011397
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011398 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011399 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011400 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11401 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11402 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011403
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011404 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11405 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11406 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11407 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11408 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011409
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011410 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011411 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011412
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011413 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11414 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11415 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011416
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011417 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11418 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11419 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011420
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011421 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11422 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11423 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11424 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11425 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011426 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011427 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011428
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011429 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11430 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011431
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011432 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11433 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11434 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11435 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11436 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11437 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11438 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11439 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11440 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011441
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011442 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11443 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011444 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11445 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11446 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011447 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011448
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011449 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011450 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011451
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011452agent-send <string>
11453 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11454 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11455 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11456 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11457 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11458
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011459agent-inter <delay>
11460 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11461 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11462
11463 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11464 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11465 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11466 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11467 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11468 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11469 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11470 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11471 of backends use the same servers.
11472
11473 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11474
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011475agent-addr <addr>
11476 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11477
11478 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11479 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11480 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11481 hostname, it will be resolved.
11482
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011483agent-port <port>
11484 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11485
11486 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11487
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011488allow-0rtt
11489 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011490 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11491 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011492
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011493alpn <protocols>
11494 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11495 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11496 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011497 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011498 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11499 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11500 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11501 now obsolete NPN extension.
11502 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11503 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11504
11505 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011507backup
11508 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11509 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11510 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11511 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011512 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11513 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011514
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011515ca-file <cafile>
11516 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11517 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11518 server's certificate.
11519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011520check
11521 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011522 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11523 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11524 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11525 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11526 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11527 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11528 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011529 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11530 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011531 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11532 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011533
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011534check-send-proxy
11535 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11536 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11537 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11538 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11539 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11540 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11541 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11542
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011543check-alpn <protocols>
11544 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11545 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11546 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11547
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011548check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011549 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011550 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11551 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011552
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011553check-ssl
11554 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11555 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11556 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11557 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011558 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011559 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11560 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011561 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011562 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11563 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011564
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011565check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011566 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011567 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11568 for normal traffic.
11569
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011570ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11572 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11573 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011574 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11575 information and recommendations see e.g.
11576 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11577 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11578 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011579
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011580ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11581 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11582 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11583 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11584 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011585 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11586 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11587 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011589cookie <value>
11590 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11591 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11592 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11593 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11594 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11595 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11596 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11597
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011598crl-file <crlfile>
11599 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11600 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11601 to verify server's certificate.
11602
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011603crt <cert>
11604 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11605 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11606 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11607 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11608 certificate request.
11609
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011610disabled
11611 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11612 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11613 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11614 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11615 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011616 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011617
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011618enabled
11619 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11620 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11621 default value.
11622 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11623 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011625error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011626 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11627 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11628 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011630 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011632fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011633 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11634 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11635 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11636
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011637force-sslv3
11638 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11639 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011640 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011641 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011642
11643force-tlsv10
11644 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011645 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011646 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011647
11648force-tlsv11
11649 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011650 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011651 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011652
11653force-tlsv12
11654 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011655 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011656 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011657
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011658force-tlsv13
11659 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11660 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011661 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011663id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011664 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11665 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11666 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011667
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011668init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11669 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11670 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011671 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011672 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11673 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11674 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11675 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11676 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11677 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11678 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11679 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11680 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011681 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011682 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11683 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11684 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11685 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11686 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11687 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011688 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011689
11690 Example:
11691 defaults
11692 # never fail on address resolution
11693 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011695inter <delay>
11696fastinter <delay>
11697downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011698 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11699 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11700 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11701 between checks depending on the server state :
11702
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011703 Server state | Interval used
11704 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11705 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11706 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11707 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11708 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11709 or yet unchecked. |
11710 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11711 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11712 | "inter" otherwise.
11713 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011715 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11716 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11717 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11718 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011719 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11720 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11721 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11722 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11723 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011724
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011725maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011726 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11727 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011728 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11729 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011730 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11731 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11732 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11733 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11734
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011735 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11736 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11737 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11738 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11739 than 50 concurrent requests.
11740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011741maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011742 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11743 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11744 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11745 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11746 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11747 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11748 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11749
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011750max-reuse <count>
11751 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11752 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11753 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11754 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11755 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11756 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11757 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11758 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11759
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011760minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011761 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11762 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11763 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11764 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11765 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11766 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011767 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011768 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011769
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011770namespace <name>
11771 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11772 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11773 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11774 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11775
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011776no-agent-check
11777 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11778 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11779 default value.
11780 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11781 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11782
11783no-backup
11784 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11785 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11786 default value.
11787 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11788 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11789
11790no-check
11791 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11792 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11793 default value.
11794 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11795 "default-server" "check" setting.
11796
11797no-check-ssl
11798 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11799 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11800 default value.
11801 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11802 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11803
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011804no-send-proxy
11805 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11806 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11807 default value.
11808 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11809 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11810
11811no-send-proxy-v2
11812 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11813 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11814 default value.
11815 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11816 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11817
11818no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11819 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11820 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11821 default value.
11822 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11823 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11824
11825no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11826 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11827 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11828 default value.
11829 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11830 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11831
11832no-ssl
11833 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11834 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11835 default value.
11836 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11837 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11838
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011839no-ssl-reuse
11840 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11841 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11842 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11843 and for paranoid users.
11844
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011845no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011846 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11847 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011848 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011849
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011850 Supported in default-server: No
11851
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011852no-tls-tickets
11853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11854 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11855 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011856 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11857 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011858 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011859
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011860no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011861 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011862 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11863 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011864 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11865 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011866 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011867
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011868 Supported in default-server: No
11869
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011870no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011871 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011872 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11873 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011874 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11875 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011876 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011877
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011878 Supported in default-server: No
11879
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011880no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011881 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011882 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11883 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011884 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11885 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011886 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011887
11888 Supported in default-server: No
11889
11890no-tlsv13
11891 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11892 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11893 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11894 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11895 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011896 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011897
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011898 Supported in default-server: No
11899
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011900no-verifyhost
11901 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11902 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11903 default value.
11904 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11905 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011906
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011907no-tfo
11908 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11909 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11910 default value.
11911 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11912 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11913
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011914non-stick
11915 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11916 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11917 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11918
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011919npn <protocols>
11920 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11921 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11922 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011923 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011924 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11925 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11926 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011928observe <mode>
11929 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11930 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11931 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11932 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11933 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11934 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011935 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011936
11937 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11938
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011939on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011940 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11941 Currently, four modes are available:
11942 - fastinter: force fastinter
11943 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11944 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11945 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11946 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11947
11948 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11949
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011950on-marked-down <action>
11951 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11952 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011953 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11954 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11955 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11956 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11957 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11958 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11959 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11960 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011961
11962 Actions are disabled by default
11963
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011964on-marked-up <action>
11965 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11966 Currently one action is available:
11967 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11968 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11969 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11970 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011971 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11972 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011973 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11974 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11975
11976 Actions are disabled by default
11977
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011978pool-max-conn <max>
11979 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11980 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11981 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11982 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11983 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11984 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11985
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011986pool-purge-delay <delay>
11987 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011988 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011989 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011991port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011992 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11993 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11994 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11995 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11996 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11997 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11998
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011999proto <name>
12000
12001 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12002 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12003 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12004 reported in haproxy -vv.
12005 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12006 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012008redir <prefix>
12009 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12010 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12011 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12012 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12013 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12014 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12015 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12016 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012017 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012018 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012019 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12020 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12021 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12022 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12023
12024 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012026rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012027 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12028 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12029 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12030
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012031resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12032 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12033 server.
12034
12035 Available options:
12036
12037 * allow-dup-ip
12038 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12039 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12040 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12041 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12042 For such case, simply enable this option.
12043 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12044
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012045 * ignore-weight
12046 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12047 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12048 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12049
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012050 * prevent-dup-ip
12051 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12052 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12053 same fqdn.
12054 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12055
12056 Example:
12057 backend b_myapp
12058 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12059 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12060 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12061
12062 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12063 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12064 it
12065 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12066 different address
12067
12068 Default value: not set
12069
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012070resolve-prefer <family>
12071 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12072 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12073 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12074 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12075
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012076 Default value: ipv6
12077
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012078 Example:
12079
12080 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012081
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012082resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012083 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012084 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012085 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012086 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12087 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012088 configured network, another address is selected.
12089
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012090 Example:
12091
12092 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012093
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012094resolvers <id>
12095 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12096 hostname.
12097
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012098 Example:
12099
12100 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012101
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012102 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012103
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012104send-proxy
12105 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12106 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12107 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12108 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012109 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12110 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12111 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12112 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12113 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12114 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12115 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12116 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12117 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12118 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012119 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12120 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012121
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012122send-proxy-v2
12123 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12124 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12125 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12126 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012127 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12128 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12129 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12130 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012131
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012132proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12133 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12134 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012135 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12136 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012137 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12138 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012139 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012140
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012141send-proxy-v2-ssl
12142 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12143 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12144 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12145 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12146 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12147 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12148 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012149 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12150 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012151
12152send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12153 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12154 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12155 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12156 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12157 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12158 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12159 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12160 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012161 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12162 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012164slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012165 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12166 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12167 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12168 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12169 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12170 parameters :
12171
12172 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12173 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12174
12175 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12176 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12177 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12178 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12179
12180 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12181 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12182 seen as failed.
12183
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012184sni <expression>
12185 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12186 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12187 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12188 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012189 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12190 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012191 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012192 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12193 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012194
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012195source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012196source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012197source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012198 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12199 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12200 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12201 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12202
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012203 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12204 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12205 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12206 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12207 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12208 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12209 server.
12210
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012211 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12212 specifying the source address without port(s).
12213
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012214ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012215 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12216 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12217 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12218 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12219 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12220 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012221 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12222 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012223
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012224ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12225 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12226 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12227 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12228
12229ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12230 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12231 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12232 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12233
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012234ssl-reuse
12235 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12236 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12237 default value.
12238 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12239 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12240
12241stick
12242 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12243 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12244 default value.
12245 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12246 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012247
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012248socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012249 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012250 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12251 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12252
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012253tcp-ut <delay>
12254 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12255 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12256 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012257 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012258 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12259 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12260 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12261 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12262 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12263 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12264 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12265 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12266 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12267
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012268tfo
12269 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12270 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12271 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12272 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12273 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012274 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012276track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012277 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12278 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12279 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12280 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012281 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12282
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012283tls-tickets
12284 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12285 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12286 default value.
12287 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12288 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012289
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012290verify [none|required]
12291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012292 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012293 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12294 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012295 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012296 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12297 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12298 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12299 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12300 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12301 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12302 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12303 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012304
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012305verifyhost <hostname>
12306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012307 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12308 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12309 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12310 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12311 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12312 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12313 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12314 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012316weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012317 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12318 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12319 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012320 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12321 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12322 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12323 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12324 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12325 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012326
12327
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123285.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12329-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012330
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012331HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12332using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12333configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012334This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12335can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12336workload.
12337This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12338resolution at run time.
12339Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12340carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12341
12342
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123435.3.1. Global overview
12344----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012345
12346As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12347different steps of the process life:
12348
12349 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12350 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12351 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12352
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012353 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12354 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012355
12356A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12357 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12358 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12359 resolution to know this new IP.
12360
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012361When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012362HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012363SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12364from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12365will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12366will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012367
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012368A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012369 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012370 first valid response.
12371
12372 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12373 servers return an error.
12374
12375
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123765.3.2. The resolvers section
12377----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012378
12379This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012380HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12381contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012382
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012383When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12384uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12385is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12386answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12387
12388When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012389used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012390
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012391 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12392 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12393 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012394
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012395 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12396 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012397
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012398 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12399 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12400 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012401
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012402For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12403following scenarios are possible:
12404
12405 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12406 ignored
12407
12408 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12409 applied
12410
12411 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12412 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12413
12414 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12415 retries the query with a new type
12416
12417 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12418 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012419
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012420As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12421a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012422<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012423
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012424
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012425resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012426 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012427
12428A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12429
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012430accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012431 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012432 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012433 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12434 by RFC 6891)
12435
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012436 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12437
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012438nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12439 DNS server description:
12440 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12441 <ip> : IP address of the server
12442 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12443
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012444parse-resolv-conf
12445 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12446 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12447 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12448
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012449hold <status> <period>
12450 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12451 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012452 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012453 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012454 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12455 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12456 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12457
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012458 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012459
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012460resolve_retries <nb>
12461 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12462 giving up.
12463 Default value: 3
12464
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012465 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12466 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12467 type.
12468
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012469timeout <event> <time>
12470 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12471 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12472 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012473 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12474 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012475 Default value: 1s
12476 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012477 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012478 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012479 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12480 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12481
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012482 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012483
12484 resolvers mydns
12485 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12486 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012487 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012488 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012489 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012490 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012491 hold other 30s
12492 hold refused 30s
12493 hold nx 30s
12494 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012495 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012496 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012497
12498
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200124996. Cache
12500---------
12501
12502HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12503(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12504RAM.
12505
12506The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12507this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12508
12509If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12510independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12511when we try to allocate a new one.
12512
12513The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12514
12515It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12516"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12517for more details.
12518
12519When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12520replaced by "<CACHE>".
12521
12522
125236.1. Limitation
12524----------------
12525
12526The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12527
12528- If the response is not a 200
12529- If the response contains a Vary header
12530- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12531- If the response is not cacheable
12532
12533- If the request is not a GET
12534- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12535- If the request contains an Authorization header
12536
12537
125386.2. Setup
12539-----------
12540
12541To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12542the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12543
12544
125456.2.1. Cache section
12546---------------------
12547
12548cache <name>
12549 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12550 size of cache is mandatory.
12551
12552total-max-size <megabytes>
12553 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12554 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12555
12556max-object-size <bytes>
12557 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12558 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12559 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12560
12561max-age <seconds>
12562 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12563 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12564 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12565 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12566 default.
12567
12568
125696.2.2. Proxy section
12570---------------------
12571
12572http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12573 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12574 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12575 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12576 after this one.
12577
12578http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12579 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12580 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12581 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12582 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12583
12584
12585Example:
12586
12587 backend bck1
12588 mode http
12589
12590 http-request cache-use foobar
12591 http-response cache-store foobar
12592 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12593
12594 cache foobar
12595 total-max-size 4
12596 max-age 240
12597
12598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125997. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12600----------------------------------
12601
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012602HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012603client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12604The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12605these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12606but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12607data called patterns.
12608
12609
126107.1. ACL basics
12611---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012612
12613The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12614content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12615from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12616simple :
12617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012618 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012619 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012620 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12621 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012623The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12624adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012625
12626In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012628 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012629
12630This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12631Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12632and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012633an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12634conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12635as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12636are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012637
12638ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12639'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12640which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12641
12642There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12643performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012645The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12646specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12647this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012648methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12649ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012650
12651Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12652 - boolean
12653 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12654 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12655 - string
12656 - data block
12657
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012658Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12659converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12660would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12661The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12662which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12663
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012664Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12665keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12666fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12667which are summarized in the table below :
12668
12669 +---------------------+-----------------+
12670 | Sample or converter | Default |
12671 | output type | matching method |
12672 +---------------------+-----------------+
12673 | boolean | bool |
12674 +---------------------+-----------------+
12675 | integer | int |
12676 +---------------------+-----------------+
12677 | ip | ip |
12678 +---------------------+-----------------+
12679 | string | str |
12680 +---------------------+-----------------+
12681 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12682 +---------------------+-----------------+
12683
12684Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12685matching method, see below.
12686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012687The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12688 - boolean
12689 - integer or integer range
12690 - IP address / network
12691 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12692 - regular expression
12693 - hex block
12694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012695The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12696
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012697 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12698 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012699 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012700 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012701 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012702 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012703 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012705The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12706read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12707if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12708lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12709will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12710beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12711a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12712lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12713exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12714
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012715The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12716parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12717ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12718a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12719check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12720
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012721The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12722socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12723file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012725Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12726loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12727
12728 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12729
12730In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12731the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12732case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12733as well.
12734
12735The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12736sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12737do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12738methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12739is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012740obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012741followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12742default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12743that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12744string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12745
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012746The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12747By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12748string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12749resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12750server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012751waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012752flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12753function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012755There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12756sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12757be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012758
12759 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12760 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012761 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12762 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12763 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12764 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012765
12766 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12767 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012768 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012769
12770 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012771 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012772
12773 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012774 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012775
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012776 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012777 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12778
12779 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12780 binary or string samples.
12781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012782 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12783 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012785 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12786 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12787 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012789 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12790 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012792 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12793 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012795 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12796 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012798 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12799 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012800 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012802 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12803 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12804 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012805
12806For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12807request, it is possible to do :
12808
12809 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12810
12811In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12812buffer, one would use the following acl :
12813
12814 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12815
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012816On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12817possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12818
12819 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12822criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12823method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12824to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12825criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12826the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012828If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012829the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12830For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012832 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12833 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12834 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12835 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012836
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012837
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012838The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12839types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12840combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12841brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12842default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012844 +-------------------------------------------------+
12845 | Input sample type |
12846 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012847 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012848 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12849 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12850 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012851 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012852 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012853 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012854 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012855 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012856 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012857 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012858 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012859 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012860 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012861 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012862 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012863 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012865 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012866 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012867 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012869 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012871 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12873 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012875
12876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128777.1.1. Matching booleans
12878------------------------
12879
12880In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12881Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12882When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12883that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12884
12885Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12886return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12887"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12888
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128907.1.2. Matching integers
12891------------------------
12892
12893Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12894enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12895to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12896
12897Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12898matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12899lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012900
12901For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12902unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12903representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12904
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012905As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12906two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12907instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12908ranges and operators.
12909
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012910For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012911operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12912Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12913of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012914
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012915Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012916
12917 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12918 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12919 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12920 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12921 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12922
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012923For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012924
12925 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12926
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012927This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12928
12929 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12930
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129327.1.3. Matching strings
12933-----------------------
12934
12935String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12936different forms :
12937
12938 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012939 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012940
12941 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012942 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012943
12944 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12945 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12946
12947 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12948 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12949
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012950 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012951 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12952 matches.
12953
12954 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12955 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12956 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012957
12958String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12959exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12960characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12961string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12962to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012963before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012964
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010012965Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
12966(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
12967Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
12968
12969Example:
12970 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
12971 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
12972
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12975---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012976
12977Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12978they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12979possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12980passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12981the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012982the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12983match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012984
12985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129867.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12987-------------------------------------
12988
12989It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12990not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12991a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12992to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12993digits may be used upper or lower case.
12994
12995Example :
12996 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12997 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12998
12999
130007.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13001---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013002
13003IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13004netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13005within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013006host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013007difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13008at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13009does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13010parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013011
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013012The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13013abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13014
13015 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13016 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13017 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13018 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13019 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13020 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13021 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13022 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13023
13024Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13025192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13026
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013027IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13028Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13029trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13030IPv6 patterns.
13031
13032HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13033following situations :
13034 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13035 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13036 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13037 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13038 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13039 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13040 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13041 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13042 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13043 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013045
130467.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13047----------------------------------
13048
13049Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13050combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13051
13052 - AND (implicit)
13053 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13054 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013056A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013058 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13061indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013063For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13064"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13065requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13066is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13067
13068 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013069 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13070 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13071 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013072
13073To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13074and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13075
13076 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13077 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13078 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13079 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13080
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013081 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013082 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13083 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13084 use_backend www if host_www
13085
13086It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13087expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13088be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13089the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13090
13091 The following rule :
13092
13093 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013094 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095
13096 Can also be written that way :
13097
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013098 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013099
13100It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13101to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13102simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13103sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13104good use is the following :
13105
13106 With named ACLs :
13107
13108 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13109 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13110 monitor fail if site_dead
13111
13112 With anonymous ACLs :
13113
13114 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13115
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013116See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13117keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013118
13119
131207.3. Fetching samples
13121---------------------
13122
13123Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13124against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13125sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13126ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13127of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13128available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13129
13130This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13131Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13132compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13133deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13134
13135The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13136matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13137method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13138indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13139
13140As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13141when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13142mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13143the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13144ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13145
13146Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13147multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13148when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013149incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13150are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013151is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13152all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13153
13154Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13155 - name
13156 - name(arg1)
13157 - name(arg1,arg2)
13158
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013159
131607.3.1. Converters
13161-----------------
13162
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013163Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13164of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13165is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13166was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013167has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013168unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13169
13170These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13171sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13172the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013173support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013174
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013175A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13176support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13177supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13178(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13179bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013181The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013182
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001318351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13184 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13185 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13186 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13187 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13188 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13189
13190 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013191 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13192 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013193 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13194 frontend http-in
13195 bind *:8081
13196 default_backend servers
13197 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13198 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13199
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013200add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013201 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013202 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013203 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13204 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013205 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013206 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13207 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13208 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13209 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013210 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013211 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013212
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013213aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13214 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13215 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13216 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13217 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13218 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13219 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13220
13221 Example:
13222 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13223 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13224
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013225and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013226 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013227 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013228 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13229 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013230 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013231 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13232 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13233 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13234 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013235 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013236 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013237
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013238b64dec
13239 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13240 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13241
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013242base64
13243 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013244 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013245 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13246
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013247bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013248 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013249 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013250 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013251 presence of a flag).
13252
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013253bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13254 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13255 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013256 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013257
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013258concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13259 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13260 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13261 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13262 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13263 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13264 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13265 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13266 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13267 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13268 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013269 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013270 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013271 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013272
13273 Example:
13274 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13275 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13276 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13277 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13278
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013279cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013280 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13281 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013282
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013283crc32([<avalanche>])
13284 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13285 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13286 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13287 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13288 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13289 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13290 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13291 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13292 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13293 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013294 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13295
13296crc32c([<avalanche>])
13297 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13298 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13299 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13300 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13301 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13302 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13303 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13304 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013305
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013306da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013307 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13308 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13309 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13310 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013311 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013312 configuration language.
13313
13314 Example:
13315 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013316 bind *:8881
13317 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013318 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013319
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013320debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13321 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13322 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13323 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13324 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13325 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13326 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13327 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13328 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13329 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13330 printable sample types.
13331
13332 Example:
13333 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013334
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013335div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013336 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13337 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013338 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013339 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13340 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013341 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013342 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13343 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13344 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13345 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013346 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013347 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013348
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013349djb2([<avalanche>])
13350 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13351 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13352 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13353 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13354 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13355 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13356 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013357 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13358 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013359
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013360even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013361 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013362 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13363
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013364field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13365 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13366 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13367 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13368 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13369 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13370 fields.
13371
13372 Example :
13373 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13374 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13375 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13376 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13377 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013378
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013379hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013380 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013381 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013382 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013383 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013384
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013385hex2i
13386 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013387 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013388
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013389http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013390 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13391 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013392 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13393 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13394 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13395 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13396 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13397 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13398 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13399 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013400
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013401in_table(<table>)
13402 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13403 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13404 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013405 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013406 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13407
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013408ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13409 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013410 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013411 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13412 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13413 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13414 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13415 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013416
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013417json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013418 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013419 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013420 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013421 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13422 of errors:
13423 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13424 bytes, ...)
13425 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13426 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13427
13428 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13429 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13430 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13431 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13432 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13433 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013434 - "ascii" : never fails;
13435 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13436 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013437 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013438 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013439 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13440 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13441
13442 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013443 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013444
13445 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013446 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013447 capture request header user-agent len 150
13448 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013449
13450 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13451 GET / HTTP/1.0
13452 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13453
13454 Output log:
13455 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13456
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013457language(<value>[,<default>])
13458 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13459 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13460 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13461 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13462 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13463 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13464 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13465 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13466 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013467 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013468 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13469 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013470
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013471 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013472
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013473 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13474 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013475
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013476 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13477 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13478 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13479 use_backend spanish if es
13480 use_backend french if fr
13481 use_backend english if en
13482 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013483
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013484length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013485 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13486 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13487 type. The result is of type integer.
13488
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013489lower
13490 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13491 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13492 type. The result is of type string.
13493
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013494ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13495 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13496 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13497 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13498 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13499 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13500 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13501
13502 Example :
13503
13504 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013505 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013506 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13507
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013508map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13509map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13510map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13511 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13512 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13513 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13514 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13515 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13516 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13517 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13518 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013519
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013520 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13521 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13522 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013523
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013524 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013525 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013526
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013527 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13528 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13529 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13530 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013531 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13532 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013533 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13534 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13535 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13536 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13537 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13538 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13539 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13540 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013541 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13542 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13543 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013544 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13545 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13546 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13547 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13548 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013549
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013550 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13551 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13552 the corresponding match text.
13553
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013554 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13555 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13556 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13557 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13558 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013559
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013560 Example :
13561
13562 # this is a comment and is ignored
13563 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13564 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13565 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13566 | | | `---------- value
13567 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13568 | `---------------------------- key
13569 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13570
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013571mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013572 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13573 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013574 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013575 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013576 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013577 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13578 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13579 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13580 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013581 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013582 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013583
13584mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013585 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013586 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13587 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013588 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013589 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013590 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013591 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13592 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13593 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13594 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013595 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013596 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013597
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013598nbsrv
13599 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13600 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13601 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13602 map lookup.
13603
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013604neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013605 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13606 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13607 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13608 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013609
13610not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013611 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013612 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013613 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013614 absence of a flag).
13615
13616odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013617 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013618 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13619
13620or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013621 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013622 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013623 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13624 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013625 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013626 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13627 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13628 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13629 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013630 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013631 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013632
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013633protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13634 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13635 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13636 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13637 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13638 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13639 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13640 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13641 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13642 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13643 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13644 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13645
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013646regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013647 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13648 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13649 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13650 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13651 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13652 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13653 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13654 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13655 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13656 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013657 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13658 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13659 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13660 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013661
13662 Example :
13663
13664 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13665 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13666 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13667 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13668
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013669capture-req(<id>)
13670 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13671 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13672
13673 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013674 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13675 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013676
13677capture-res(<id>)
13678 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13679 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13680
13681 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013682 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13683 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013684
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013685sdbm([<avalanche>])
13686 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13687 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13688 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13689 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13690 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13691 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13692 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013693 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13694 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013695
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013696set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013697 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13698 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13699 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013700 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013701 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13702 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013703 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013704 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13705 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013706 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013707 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013708
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013709sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013710 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013711 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13712
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013713sha2([<bits>])
13714 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13715 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13716
13717 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13718 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13719
13720 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13721 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13722
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013723srv_queue
13724 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13725 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13726 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13727 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13728 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13729
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013730strcmp(<var>)
13731 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13732 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13733 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13734 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13735 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13736 shorter).
13737
13738 Example :
13739
13740 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13741 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13742 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13743
13744
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013745sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013746 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13747 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013748 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013749 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13750 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013751 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013752 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13753 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013754 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013755 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13756 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013757 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013758 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013759
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013760table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13761 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13762 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13763 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13764 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13765 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13766 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13767
13768
13769table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13770 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13771 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13772 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13773 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13774 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13775 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13776
13777table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13778 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13779 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013780 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013781 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13782 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13783
13784table_conn_cur(<table>)
13785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13787 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13788 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13789 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13790
13791table_conn_rate(<table>)
13792 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13793 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13794 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13795 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13796 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13797
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013798table_gpt0(<table>)
13799 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13800 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13801 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13802 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13803 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13804
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013805table_gpc0(<table>)
13806 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13807 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13808 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13809 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13810 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13811
13812table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13813 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13814 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13815 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13816 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13817 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13818 sample fetch keyword.
13819
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013820table_gpc1(<table>)
13821 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13822 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13823 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13824 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13825 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13826
13827table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13828 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13829 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13830 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13831 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13832 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13833 sample fetch keyword.
13834
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013835table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13836 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13837 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013838 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013839 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13840 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13841
13842table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13843 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13844 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13845 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13846 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13847 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13848 keyword.
13849
13850table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13851 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13852 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013853 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013854 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13855 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13856
13857table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13858 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13859 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13860 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13861 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13862 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13863 keyword.
13864
13865table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013869 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13870 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13871 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13872 keyword.
13873
13874table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013878 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13879 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13880 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13881 keyword.
13882
13883table_server_id(<table>)
13884 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13885 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13886 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13887 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13888 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13889 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13890
13891table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13892 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13893 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013894 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013895 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13896 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13897 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13898 keyword.
13899
13900table_sess_rate(<table>)
13901 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13902 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13903 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13904 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13905 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13906 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13907 keyword.
13908
13909table_trackers(<table>)
13910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13913 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13914 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13915 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13916 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13917 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13918 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13919 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13920
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013921upper
13922 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13923 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13924 type. The result is of type string.
13925
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013926url_dec
13927 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13928 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13929
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013930ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013931 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013932 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13933 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13934 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013935 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13936 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13937 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13938 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013939 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013940 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13941 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013942
13943 Example:
13944 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13945 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13946
13947 message Point {
13948 int32 latitude = 1;
13949 int32 longitude = 2;
13950 }
13951
13952 message PPoint {
13953 Point point = 59;
13954 }
13955
13956 message Rectangle {
13957 // One corner of the rectangle.
13958 PPoint lo = 48;
13959 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13960 PPoint hi = 49;
13961 }
13962
13963 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13964 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13965 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13966
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013967 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13968 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013969 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013970 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13971
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013972 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013973
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013974 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013975
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013976 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013977 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13978 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13979
13980 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13981 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13982 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13983
13984 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13985 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13986 interpret the previous binary sample.
13987
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013988
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013989unset-var(<var name>)
13990 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13991 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13992 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13993 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13994 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13995 response),
13996 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13997 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13998 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13999 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14000
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014001utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14002 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14003 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14004 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14005 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14006 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14007 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14008
14009 Example :
14010
14011 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014012 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014013 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14014
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014015word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14016 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14017 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14018 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14019 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14020 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14021
14022 Example :
14023 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14024 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14025 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14026 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14027 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014028
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014029wt6([<avalanche>])
14030 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14031 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14032 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14033 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14034 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14035 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14036 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014037 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14038 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014039
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014040xor(<value>)
14041 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014042 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014043 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014044 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014045 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014046 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14047 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014048 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014049 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14050 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014051 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014052 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014053
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014054xxh32([<seed>])
14055 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14056 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14057 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14058 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14059 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14060 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14061 as cryptographically secure.
14062
14063xxh64([<seed>])
14064 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14065 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14066 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14067 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14068 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14069 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14070 as cryptographically secure.
14071
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014072
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014074--------------------------------------------
14075
14076A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14077not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14078"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14079The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14080
14081always_false : boolean
14082 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14083 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14084
14085always_true : boolean
14086 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14087 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14088
14089avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014090 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014091 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14092 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14093 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14094 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14095 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14096 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14097 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14098 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14099 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14100 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14101 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14102 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14103 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014105be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014106 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14107 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14108 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14109 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014110 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14111
14112be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14113 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14114 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14115 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14116 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14117 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014118 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14119 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014120
14121 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14122 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14123 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014125be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14126 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14127 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14128 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014129 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014130 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14131 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014132
14133 Example :
14134 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14135 backend dynamic
14136 mode http
14137 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14138 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014140bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014141 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14142 of the string.
14143
14144bool(<bool>) : bool
14145 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14146 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014148connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14149 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014150 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014151 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14152 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014153
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014154 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014155 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014156 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14157
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014158 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14159 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014160
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014161 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014162 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014163 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014164 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014165 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014166 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014167 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014168
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014169 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14170 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014171 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014172 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014173
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014174cpu_calls : integer
14175 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14176 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14177 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14178 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14179 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14180 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14181
14182cpu_ns_avg : integer
14183 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14184 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14185 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14186 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14187 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14188 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14189 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14190 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14191 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14192 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14193 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14194
14195cpu_ns_tot : integer
14196 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14197 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14198 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14199 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14200 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14201 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14202 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14203 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14204 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14205 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14206 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14207 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14208 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14209
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014210date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014211 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014212
14213 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14214 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14215 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014216 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14217
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014218 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14219 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14220 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14221 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14222 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14223
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014224 Example :
14225
14226 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14227 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014228
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014229 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14230 # millisecond granularity
14231 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14232
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014233date_us : integer
14234 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14235 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14236 from the same timeval structure.
14237
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014238distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14239 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14240 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14241 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14242 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14243 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14244 list of supported tokens.
14245
14246distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14247 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14248 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14249 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14250 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14251 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14252 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14253 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14254 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14255 supported tokens.
14256
14257 Example :
14258 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14259 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14260 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14261 # send large files to the big farm
14262 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14263
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014264env(<name>) : string
14265 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14266 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14267 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14268 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14269 certain way.
14270
14271 Examples :
14272 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14273 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14274
14275 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14276 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014278fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14279 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014280 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14281 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014282 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14283 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014284 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014285 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14286 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014287
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014288fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14289 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14290 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14291 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014293fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14294 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14295 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14296 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14297 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14298 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14299 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14300 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14301 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014302
14303 Example :
14304 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14305 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14306 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14307 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14308 frontend mail
14309 bind :25
14310 mode tcp
14311 maxconn 100
14312 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14313 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14314 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14315 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014316
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014317hostname : string
14318 Returns the system hostname.
14319
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014320int(<integer>) : signed integer
14321 Returns a signed integer.
14322
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014323ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14324 Returns an ipv4.
14325
14326ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14327 Returns an ipv6.
14328
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014329lat_ns_avg : integer
14330 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14331 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14332 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14333 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14334 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14335 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14336 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14337 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14338 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14339 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14340 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14341 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14342 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14343 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14344
14345lat_ns_tot : integer
14346 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14347 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14348 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14349 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14350 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14351 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14352 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14353 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14354 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14355 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14356 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14357 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14358 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14359 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14360 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14361 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14362 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14363 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14364 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14365
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014366meth(<method>) : method
14367 Returns a method.
14368
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014369nbproc : integer
14370 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14371 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14372 and debugging purposes.
14373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014374nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14375 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14376 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14377 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014378 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14379 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14380 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014381
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014382prio_class : integer
14383 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14384 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14385 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14386
14387prio_offset : integer
14388 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14389 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14390 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14391 set-priority-offset".
14392
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014393proc : integer
14394 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14395 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14396 debugging purposes.
14397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014399 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14400 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14401 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014402 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14403 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14404 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14405 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14406 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14407
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014408rand([<range>]) : integer
14409 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14410 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14411 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14412 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14413 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14414
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014415uuid([<version>]) : string
14416 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14417 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14418 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014420srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14421 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14422 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14423 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14424 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14425 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014426 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14427 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14428
14429srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14431 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14432 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14433 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14434 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14435 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14436 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14437
14438 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14439 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014440
14441srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14442 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14443 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14444 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014445 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014446 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14447 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14448 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14449
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014450srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14451 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14452 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14453 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14454 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14455 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14456 fetch methods.
14457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014458srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14459 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14460 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014461 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014462 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14463 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014464 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014465 overloading servers).
14466
14467 Example :
14468 # Redirect to a separate back
14469 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14470 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14471 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14472
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014473stopping : boolean
14474 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14475 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14476 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14477
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014478str(<string>) : string
14479 Returns a string.
14480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014481table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14482 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14483 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14484
14485table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14486 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14487 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14488 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14489
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014490thread : integer
14491 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14492 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14493 and debugging purposes.
14494
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014495var(<var-name>) : undefined
14496 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014497 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14498 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014499 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014500 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14501 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014502 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014503 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14504 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014505 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014506 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014507
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200145087.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509----------------------------------
14510
14511The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14512closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14513methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14514sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14515TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014516the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14517counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014518"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14519used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14520can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14521Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14522table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14523tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14524currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014525
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014526bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014527 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14528 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14529 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014531be_id : integer
14532 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14533 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14534
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014535be_name : string
14536 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14537 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014539dst : ip
14540 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14541 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14542 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14543 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014544 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14545 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14546 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14547 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14548 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14549 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014550
14551dst_conn : integer
14552 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14553 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14554 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14555 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14556 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14557 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14558 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14559 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014560
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014561dst_is_local : boolean
14562 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14563 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14564 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14565 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014566 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014567 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14568 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14569 it only once per connection.
14570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014571dst_port : integer
14572 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14573 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14574 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14575 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14576 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14577 an HTTP header.
14578
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014579fc_http_major : integer
14580 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14581 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14582 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14583
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014584fc_pp_authority : string
14585 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14586 if any.
14587
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014588fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14589 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14590 header.
14591
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014592fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14593 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14594 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14595 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14596 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14597 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14598 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14599
14600fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14601 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14602 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14603 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14604 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14605 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14606 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14607
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014608fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014609 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14610 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14611 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14612 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14613
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014614fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014615 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14616 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14617 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14618 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14619
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014620fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014621 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14622 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14623 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14624 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14625
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014626fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014627 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14628 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14629 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14630 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14631
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014632fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014633 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14634 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14635 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14636 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14637
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014638fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014639 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14640 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14641 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14642 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14643
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014644fe_defbe : string
14645 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14646 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648fe_id : integer
14649 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014650 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014651 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14652
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014653fe_name : string
14654 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14655 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14656 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14657
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014658sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014659sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14660sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14661sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014662 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14663 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14664 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14665
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014666sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014667sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14668sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14669sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014670 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14671 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14672 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14673
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014674sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014675sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14676sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14677sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014678 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14679 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014680 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14681 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14682 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014683
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014684 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014685 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14686 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014687 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14688 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14689 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014690 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14691 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14692
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014693sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14694sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14695sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14696sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14697 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14698 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14699 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14700 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14701 when a first ACL was verified.
14702
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014703sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014704sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14705sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14706sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014707 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014708 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14709
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014710sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014711sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14712sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14713sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014714 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14715 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14716 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014718sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014719sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14720sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14721sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014722 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14723 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14724 See also src_conn_rate.
14725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014726sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014727sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14728sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14729sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014730 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014731 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014732
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014733sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14734sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14735sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14736sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14737 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14738 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14739
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014740sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14741sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14742sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14743sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14744 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14745 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14746
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014747sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014748sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14749sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14750sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014751 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14752 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14753 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014754 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14755 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14756 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014757
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014758sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14759sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14760sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14761sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14762 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14763 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14764 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14765 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14766 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14767 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14768
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014769sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014770sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14771sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14772sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014773 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014774 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14775 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014777sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014778sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14779sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14780sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014781 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14782 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14783 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14784 src_http_err_rate.
14785
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014786sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014787sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14788sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14789sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014790 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014791 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14792 src_http_req_cnt.
14793
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014794sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014795sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14796sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14797sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014798 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14799 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14800 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14801 src_http_req_rate.
14802
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014803sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014804sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14805sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14806sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014807 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014808 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14809 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14810 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14811 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014812
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014813 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014814 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14815 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014816 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14817
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014818sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14819sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14820sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14821sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14822 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14823 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14824 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14825 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14826 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14827
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014828sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014829sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14830sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14831sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014832 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14833 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14834 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014835
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014836sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014837sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14838sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14839sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014840 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14841 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14842 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014843
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014844sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014845sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14846sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14847sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014848 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014849 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14850 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14851 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014852 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014853 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14854
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014855sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014856sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14857sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14858sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014859 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14860 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14861 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14862 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14863 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014864 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014865
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014866sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014867sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14868sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14869sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014870 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14871 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14872 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14873
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014874sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014875sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14876sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14877sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014878 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14879 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014880 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014881 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14882 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14884 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14885 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014887so_id : integer
14888 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14889 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14890 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014893 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014894 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14895 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14896 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014897 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14898 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14899 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014900 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14901 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14902 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14903 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14904 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14905 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14906 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014907
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014908 Example:
14909 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14910 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14913 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14914 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14915 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014916 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14919 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14920 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014921 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014922 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14925 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14926 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14927 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14928 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14929 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14930 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014931
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014932 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014933 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14934 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14935 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14936 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014937 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014938 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14939 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14940
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014941src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14942 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14943 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14944 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14945 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14946 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14947 was verified.
14948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014949src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014950 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014951 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014952 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014953 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014955src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014956 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14958 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014959 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014961src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14962 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14963 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14964 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014965 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014968 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014970 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014971 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014972
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014973src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14974 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14975 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14976 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14977 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14978
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014979src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14980 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14981 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14982 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14983 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014986 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014987 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014988 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14989 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014990 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14991 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14992 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014993
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014994src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14995 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14996 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14997 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14998 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14999 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15000 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15001 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015004 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015005 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015006 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015007 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015008 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015010src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15011 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15012 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15013 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15014 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015015 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015018 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015019 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15020 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015021 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015023src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15024 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15025 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15026 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015027 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015028 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015030src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15031 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15032 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15033 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015034 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015035 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15036 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015037
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015038 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015039 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015040 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015041 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015042
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015043src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15044 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15045 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15046 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15047 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15048 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15049 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15050
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015051src_is_local : boolean
15052 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15053 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15054 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15055 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015056 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015057 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15058 once per connection.
15059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015061 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15062 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15063 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15064 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15065 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015067src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015068 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15069 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15070 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15071 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15072 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074src_port : integer
15075 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15076 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15077 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15078 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015081 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015082 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15083 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15084 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015085 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15088 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15089 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15090 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15091 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015092 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015094src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15095 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15096 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15097 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15098 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15099 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15100 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15101 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15102 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015103
15104 Example :
15105 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15106 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15107 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15108 listen ssh
15109 bind :22
15110 mode tcp
15111 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015112 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015113 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015114 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015116srv_id : integer
15117 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15118 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15119 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015120
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015121srv_name : string
15122 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15123 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15124 debugging.
15125
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151267.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015127----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015129The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15130closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15131when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15132usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015133future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015134
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001513551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15136 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15137 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15138 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15139 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15140 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15141
15142 Example :
15143 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15144 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15145 # the request.
15146 frontend http-in
15147 bind *:8081
15148 default_backend servers
15149 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15150 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15151
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015152ssl_bc : boolean
15153 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15154 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15155 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15156
15157ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15158 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15159 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15160
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015161ssl_bc_alpn : string
15162 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15163 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015164 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015165 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15166 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15167 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15168 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15169 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15170 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15171
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015172ssl_bc_cipher : string
15173 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15174 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15175
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015176ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15177 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15178 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15179 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15180
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015181ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15182 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15183 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15184 session or a TLS ticket.
15185
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015186ssl_bc_npn : string
15187 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15188 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015189 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015190 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15191 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15192 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15193 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15194 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15195
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015196ssl_bc_protocol : string
15197 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15198 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15199
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015200ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015201 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015202 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15203 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015204
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015205ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15206 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15207 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15208 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15209
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015210ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15211 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15212 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15213 if session was reused or not.
15214
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015215ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15216 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15217 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15218 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15219 BoringSSL.
15220
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015221ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15222 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15223 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015225ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15226 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15227 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15228 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15229 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15230 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15233 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15234 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15235 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15236 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015237
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015238ssl_c_der : binary
15239 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15240 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15241 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015243ssl_c_err : integer
15244 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15245 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15246 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15247 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15248 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015249
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015250ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15252 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15253 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15254 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15255 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15256 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15257 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15258 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015259 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15260 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15261 LDAP v3.
15262 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15263 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015265ssl_c_key_alg : string
15266 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15267 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15268 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015270ssl_c_notafter : string
15271 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15272 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15273 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275ssl_c_notbefore : string
15276 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15277 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15278 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015279
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015280ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15282 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15283 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15284 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15285 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15286 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15287 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15288 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015289 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15290 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15291 LDAP v3.
15292 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15293 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295ssl_c_serial : binary
15296 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15297 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15298 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15301 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15302 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15303 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015304 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15305 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15306
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015307 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015308 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015310ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15311 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15312 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15313 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015315ssl_c_used : boolean
15316 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15317 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015319ssl_c_verify : integer
15320 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15321 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15322 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15323 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015325ssl_c_version : integer
15326 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15327 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015328
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015329ssl_f_der : binary
15330 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15331 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15332 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15333
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015334ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015335 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15336 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15337 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15338 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015339 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015340 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15341 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15342 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015343 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15344 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15345 LDAP v3.
15346 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15347 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015349ssl_f_key_alg : string
15350 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15351 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15352 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015354ssl_f_notafter : string
15355 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15356 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15357 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015359ssl_f_notbefore : string
15360 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15361 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15362 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015363
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015364ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015365 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15366 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15367 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15368 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15369 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15370 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15371 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15372 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015373 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15374 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15375 LDAP v3.
15376 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15377 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015379ssl_f_serial : binary
15380 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15381 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15382 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015383
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015384ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15385 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15386 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15387 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015389ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15390 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15391 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15392 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015394ssl_f_version : integer
15395 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15396 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15397
15398ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015399 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15400 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15401 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015403 Example :
15404 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15405 listen http-https
15406 bind :80
15407 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15408 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15409
15410ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15411 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15412 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15413
15414ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015415 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015416 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15417 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15418 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15419 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15420 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15421 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15422 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15423 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425ssl_fc_cipher : string
15426 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15427 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015428
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015429ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15430 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15431 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015432 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015433
15434ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15435 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15436 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015437 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015438
15439ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15440 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15441 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15442 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015443 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015444 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015445
15446ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15447 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15448 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015449 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015450
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015451ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15452 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15453 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15454 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015456ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015457 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15458 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015459 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15460 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15461 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15462 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015463
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015464ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15465 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15466 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15467 wait until the handshake happened.
15468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015469ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15470 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015471 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15472 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015473 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015474 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015475
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015476ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015477 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015478 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15479 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015482 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015483 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15484 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15485 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15486 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15487 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15488 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15489 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491ssl_fc_protocol : string
15492 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15493 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015494
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015495ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015496 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015497 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15498 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015499
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015500ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15501 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15502 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15503 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015505ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15506 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15507 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15508 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15509 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015510
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015511ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15512 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15513 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15514 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15515 BoringSSL.
15516
15517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518ssl_fc_sni : string
15519 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15520 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15521 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15522 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15523 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15524
15525 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15526 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15527 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015528 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015529 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15533 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015535ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15536 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15537 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015538
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015539
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155407.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015541------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15544sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15545only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15546For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15547be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15548can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15549sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15550for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15551content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015554 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15556 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15559 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015560 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015562
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015563req.hdrs : string
15564 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15565 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15566 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15567 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15568
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015569req.hdrs_bin : binary
15570 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15571 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15572 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15573 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15574 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15575 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15576
15577 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15578
15579 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15580 str: <int:length><bytes>
15581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015582req.len : integer
15583req_len : integer (deprecated)
15584 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15585 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15586 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15587 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15588 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15589 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15590 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15591 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15594 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015595 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15596 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15597 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15598 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600 ACL alternatives :
15601 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015603req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15604 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15605 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15606 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15607 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609 ACL alternatives :
15610 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015614req.proto_http : boolean
15615req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15616 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15617 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15618 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15619 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15620 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15621 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15622 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624 Example:
15625 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15626 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15627 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015628 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15631rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15632 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15633 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15634 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15635 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15636 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15637 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15638 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15641 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15642 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15643 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15644 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15645 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647 ACL derivatives :
15648 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650 Example :
15651 listen tse-farm
15652 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15653 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15654 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15655 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15656 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15657 persist rdp-cookie
15658 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15659 # This is only useful makes sense if
15660 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15661 stick-table type string size 204800
15662 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15663 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15664 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15667 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15670rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15671 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15672 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15673 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15674 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015676 ACL derivatives :
15677 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015678
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015679req.ssl_alpn : string
15680 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15681 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15682 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15683 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15684 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15685 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015686 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015687
15688 Examples :
15689 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15690 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15691 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015692 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015693 default_backend bk_default
15694
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015695req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15696 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15697 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015698 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15699 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15700 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15701 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15702 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15705req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15706 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15707 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15708 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15709 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15710 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15711 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15712 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714req.ssl_sni : string
15715req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15716 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15717 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15718 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15719 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15720 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15721 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15722 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15723 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15724 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15725 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15726 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15727 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729 ACL derivatives :
15730 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732 Examples :
15733 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15734 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15735 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15736 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15737 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015738
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015739req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15740 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15741 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15742 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15743 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15744 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15745 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15746 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15747 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15748 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015750req.ssl_ver : integer
15751req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15752 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15753 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15754 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15755 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15756 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15757 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15758 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015759 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762 ACL derivatives :
15763 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015764
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015765res.len : integer
15766 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15767 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15768 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15769 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15770 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15771 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15772 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15773 content inspection.
15774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015775res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15776 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015777 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15778 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15779 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15780 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015782res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15783 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15784 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15785 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15786 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015789
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015790res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15791rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15792 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15793 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15794 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15795 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15796 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15797 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15798 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015800wait_end : boolean
15801 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15802 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015803 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15805 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015806 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15808 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810 Examples :
15811 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15812 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15813 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015815 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15816 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15817 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15818 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15819 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15820 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15821 tcp-request content reject
15822
15823
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158247.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015825--------------------------------------
15826
15827It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15828This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15829data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15830its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15831HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15832content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15833to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15834more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15835response are indexed.
15836
15837base : string
15838 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15839 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15840 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15841 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15842 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15843 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15844 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15845 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15846
15847 ACL derivatives :
15848 base : exact string match
15849 base_beg : prefix match
15850 base_dir : subdir match
15851 base_dom : domain match
15852 base_end : suffix match
15853 base_len : length match
15854 base_reg : regex match
15855 base_sub : substring match
15856
15857base32 : integer
15858 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15859 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15860 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015861 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15862 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15863 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015864
15865base32+src : binary
15866 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15867 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15868 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15869 per-URL counters.
15870
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015871capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15872 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15873 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15874 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15875
15876capture.req.method : string
15877 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15878 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15879 because it's allocated.
15880
15881capture.req.uri : string
15882 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15883 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15884 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15885 allocated.
15886
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015887capture.req.ver : string
15888 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15889 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15890 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15891
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015892capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15893 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15894 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15895 The first entry is an index of 0.
15896 See also: "capture response header"
15897
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015898capture.res.ver : string
15899 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15900 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15901 persistent flag.
15902
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015903req.body : binary
15904 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15905 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15906 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15907 the first chunk is analyzed.
15908
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015909req.body_param([<name>) : string
15910 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15911 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15912 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15913 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15914 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15915 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15916 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15917 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15918 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15919 given.
15920
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015921req.body_len : integer
15922 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15923 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15924 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15925 "option http-buffer-request".
15926
15927req.body_size : integer
15928 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15929 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15930 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15931 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15932 "option http-buffer-request".
15933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934req.cook([<name>]) : string
15935cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15936 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15937 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15938 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15939 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15940 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15941 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15942 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15943 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15944
15945 ACL derivatives :
15946 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15947 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15948 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15949 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15950 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15951 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15952 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15953 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015955req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15956cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15957 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15958 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15961cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15962 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15963 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15964 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15965 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15968 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15969 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15970 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15971 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015972 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015973 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15974 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15975 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15976 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15979 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15980 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15981 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15982 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015983 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015985req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15986 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15987 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15988 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15989 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15990 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15991 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15992 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15993 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015995req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15996 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15997 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15998 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15999 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016001req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16002 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16003 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16004 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16005 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16006 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16007 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16008 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16009 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016010 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016012 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014 ACL derivatives :
16015 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16016 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16017 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16018 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16019 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16020 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16021 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16022 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16023
16024req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16025hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16026 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16027 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16028 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16029 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16030 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16031 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16032 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16033 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16034 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16035
16036req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16037hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16038 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16039 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16040 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16041 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16042 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016043 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016044 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16045 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16046
16047req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16048hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16049 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16050 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16051 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16052 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16053 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16054 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16055 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16056
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016057
16058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16060 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16061 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16062 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16063 basic auth is supported.
16064
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016065http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16066 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16067 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16068 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16069 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016070 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16071 basic auth is supported.
16072
16073 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016074 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16075 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16076 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16077 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016078
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016079http_auth_pass : string
16080 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16081 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16082 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16083
16084http_auth_type : string
16085 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16086 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16087 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16088
16089http_auth_user : string
16090 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16091 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16092 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016095 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16096 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16098 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100method : integer + string
16101 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16102 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16103 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16104 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16105 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16106 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16107 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109 ACL derivatives :
16110 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112 Example :
16113 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16114 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16115 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016117path : string
16118 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16119 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16120 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16121 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16122 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016123 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126 ACL derivatives :
16127 path : exact string match
16128 path_beg : prefix match
16129 path_dir : subdir match
16130 path_dom : domain match
16131 path_end : suffix match
16132 path_len : length match
16133 path_reg : regex match
16134 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016135
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016136query : string
16137 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16138 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16139 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16140 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016141 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016142 which stops before the question mark.
16143
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016144req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16145 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16146 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16147 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16148 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016150req.ver : string
16151req_ver : string (deprecated)
16152 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16153 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16154 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156 ACL derivatives :
16157 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159res.comp : boolean
16160 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16161 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16162 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016164res.comp_algo : string
16165 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16166 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16167 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169res.cook([<name>]) : string
16170scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16171 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16172 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16173 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016175 ACL derivatives :
16176 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16179scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16180 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16181 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16182 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016184res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16185scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16186 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16187 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16188 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16191 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16192 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16193 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16194 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16195 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16196 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16197 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16198 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16199 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016201res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16202 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16203 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16204 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16205 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16206 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16209shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16210 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16211 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16212 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16213 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16214 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16215 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16216 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16217 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016219 ACL derivatives :
16220 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16221 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16222 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16223 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16224 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16225 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16226 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16227 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16228
16229res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16230shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16231 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16232 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16233 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16234 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16235 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16238shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16239 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16240 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16241 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16242 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16243 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16244 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016245
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016246res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16247 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16248 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16249 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16250 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16253shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16254 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16255 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16256 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16257 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16258 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16259 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016261res.ver : string
16262resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16263 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16264 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266 ACL derivatives :
16267 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016269set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16270 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16271 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016272 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016273 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016275 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16276 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278status : integer
16279 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16280 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16281 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016282
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016283unique-id : string
16284 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16285 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16286 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16287 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16288 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16289 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016291url : string
16292 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16293 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16294 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16295 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16296 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16297 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16298 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016300 ACL derivatives :
16301 url : exact string match
16302 url_beg : prefix match
16303 url_dir : subdir match
16304 url_dom : domain match
16305 url_end : suffix match
16306 url_len : length match
16307 url_reg : regex match
16308 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016310url_ip : ip
16311 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16312 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16313 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16314 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16315 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16316 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16317 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016319url_port : integer
16320 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16321 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16322 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16323 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016324
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016325urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16326url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016327 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16328 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016329 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16330 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16331 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16332 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016333 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16334 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016335 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16336 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016338 ACL derivatives :
16339 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16340 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16341 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16342 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16343 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16344 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16345 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16346 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016347
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016349 Example :
16350 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16351 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16352 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16353 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016354
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016355urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016356 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16357 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16358 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016359
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016360url32 : integer
16361 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16362 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16363 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16364 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16365 is an unsigned integer.
16366
16367url32+src : binary
16368 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16369 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16370 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16371
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016372
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100163737.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16374---------------------------------------
16375
16376This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16377used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16378purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16379There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16380or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16381any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16382for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16383
16384internal.htx.data : integer
16385 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16386 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16387
16388internal.htx.free : integer
16389 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16390 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16391
16392internal.htx.free_data : integer
16393 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16394 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16395
16396internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16397 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16398 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16399 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16400
16401internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16402 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16403 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16404
16405internal.htx.size : integer
16406 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16407 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16408
16409internal.htx.used : integer
16410 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16411 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16412 direction.
16413
16414internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16415 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16416 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16417 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16418 of the special value :
16419 * head : The oldest inserted block
16420 * tail : The newest inserted block
16421 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16422
16423internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16424 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16425 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16426 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16427 integer or one of the special value :
16428 * head : The oldest inserted block
16429 * tail : The newest inserted block
16430 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16431
16432internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16433 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16434 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16435 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16436 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16437
16438 * head : The oldest inserted block
16439 * tail : The newest inserted block
16440 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16441
16442internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16443 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16444 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16445 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16446 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16447
16448 * head : The oldest inserted block
16449 * tail : The newest inserted block
16450 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16451
16452internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16453 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16454 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16455 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16456 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16457
16458 * head : The oldest inserted block
16459 * tail : The newest inserted block
16460 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16461
16462internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16463 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16464 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16465 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16466 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16467
16468 * head : The oldest inserted block
16469 * tail : The newest inserted block
16470 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16471
16472internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16473 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16474 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16475 it returns false.
16476
16477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200164787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016479---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016481Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16482every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016483order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016485ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16486---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016487FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016488HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016489HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16490HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016491HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16492HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16493HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16494HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16495LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016496METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016497METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016498METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16499METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16500METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16501METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016502METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016503METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016504RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016505REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016506TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016507WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16508---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016509
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165118. Logging
16512----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016513
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016514One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16515provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16516very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16517provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16518state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016519to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016520headers.
16521
16522In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16523about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16524send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16525
16526 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16527 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16528 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16529 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16530 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016531 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016532 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016533
16534The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16535allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16536as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16537while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16538real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16539delay.
16540
16541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165428.1. Log levels
16543---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016544
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016545TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016546source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016547HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16548in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16549track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16550syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16551about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016552
16553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165548.2. Log formats
16555----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016556
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016557HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016558and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16559slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16560options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016561
16562 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16563 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16564 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16565 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16566 extents.
16567
16568 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16569 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16570 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16571 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16572 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16573
16574 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16575 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16576 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16577 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16578 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16579
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016580 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16581 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16582 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16583 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16584
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016585 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16586
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016587Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16588specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16589field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16590servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16591always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16592identifier.
16593
16594Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16595 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16596 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16597 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16598 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16599
16600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166018.2.1. Default log format
16602-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016603
16604This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16605as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16606format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16607
16608 Example :
16609 listen www
16610 mode http
16611 log global
16612 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16613
16614 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16615 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16616 (www/HTTP)
16617
16618 Field Format Extract from the example above
16619 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16620 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16621 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16622 4 'to' to
16623 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16624 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16625
16626Detailed fields description :
16627 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16628 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16629 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16630 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16631 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16632 and processed the connection.
16633 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16634
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016635In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16636"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16637connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16638
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016639It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16640will eventually disappear.
16641
16642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166438.2.2. TCP log format
16644---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016645
16646The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16647is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16648information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16649counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16650emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16651environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16652the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16653sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016654specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16655not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16656fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16657marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016658
16659 Example :
16660 frontend fnt
16661 mode tcp
16662 option tcplog
16663 log global
16664 default_backend bck
16665
16666 backend bck
16667 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16668
16669 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16670 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16671 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16672
16673 Field Format Extract from the example above
16674 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16675 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16676 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16677 4 frontend_name fnt
16678 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16679 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16680 7 bytes_read* 212
16681 8 termination_state --
16682 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16683 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16684
16685Detailed fields description :
16686 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016687 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16688 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16689 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016690 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016691 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016692 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016693
16694 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016695 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16696 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16697 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016698
16699 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16700 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16701 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016702 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16703 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16704 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16705 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016706
16707 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16708 and processed the connection.
16709
16710 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16711 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16712 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16713 applications.
16714
16715 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16716 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16717 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16718 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16719 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16720
16721 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16722 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16723 See "Timers" below for more details.
16724
16725 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16726 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16727 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16728 "Timers" below for more details.
16729
16730 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016731 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016732 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16733 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16734 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16735 details.
16736
16737 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16738 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16739 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16740 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16741 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16742
16743 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16744 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16745 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16746 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16747 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16748 for more details.
16749
16750 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016751 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016752 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16753 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16754 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016755 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016756
16757 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16758 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16759 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16760 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16761 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16762 caused by a denial of service attack.
16763
16764 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16765 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16766 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16767 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16768 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16769 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16770 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16771 denial of service attack.
16772
16773 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16774 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16775 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16776 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16777 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16778 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16779 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16780 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16781 be processed than on other servers.
16782
16783 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16784 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16785 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16786 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16787 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16788 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16789 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16790 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16791 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16792 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16793 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16794 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16795 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16796
16797 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16798 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16799 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16800 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16801 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16802 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016803 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016804 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16805
16806 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16807 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16808 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16809 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16810 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16811 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016812 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016813 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16814 occurs.
16815
16816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168178.2.3. HTTP log format
16818----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016819
16820The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16821is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16822the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16823are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16824emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16825generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16826"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16827which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016828frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16829is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016830
16831Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16832slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16833with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16834
16835 Example :
16836 frontend http-in
16837 mode http
16838 option httplog
16839 log global
16840 default_backend bck
16841
16842 backend static
16843 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16844
16845 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16846 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16847 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016848 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016849
16850 Field Format Extract from the example above
16851 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16852 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016853 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016854 4 frontend_name http-in
16855 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016856 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016857 7 status_code 200
16858 8 bytes_read* 2750
16859 9 captured_request_cookie -
16860 10 captured_response_cookie -
16861 11 termination_state ----
16862 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16863 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16864 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16865 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16866 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016867
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016868Detailed fields description :
16869 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016870 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16871 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16872 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016873 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016874 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016875 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016876
16877 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016878 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16879 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16880 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016881
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016882 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16883 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016884
16885 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16886 and processed the connection.
16887
16888 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16889 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16890 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16891
16892 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16893 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16894 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16895 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16896 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16897 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16898
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016899 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16900 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16901 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016902 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016903 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16904 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016905 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16906 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016907
16908 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16909 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016910 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016911
16912 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16913 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016914 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16915 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016916
16917 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16918 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16919 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16920 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16921 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016922 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16923 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016924
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016925 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16926 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16927 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16928 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16929 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16930 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16931 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016932 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016933
16934 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16935 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16936 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16937
16938 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16939 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016940 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016941 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16942 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16943 overflowing.
16944
16945 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16946 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16947 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16948 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16949 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16950 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16951 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16952 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16953
16954 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16955 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16956 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16957 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16958 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16959 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16960 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16961 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16962
16963 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16964 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16965 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16966 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16967 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16968 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16969 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16970
16971 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016972 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016973 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16974 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16975 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016976 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016977 system.
16978
16979 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16980 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16981 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16982 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16983 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16984 caused by a denial of service attack.
16985
16986 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16987 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16988 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16989 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16990 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16991 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16992 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16993 denial of service attack.
16994
16995 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16996 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16997 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16998 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16999 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17000 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17001 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17002 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17003 processed than on other servers.
17004
17005 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17006 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17007 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17008 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17009 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17010 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17011 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17012 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17013 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17014 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17015 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17016 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17017 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17018
17019 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17020 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17021 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17022 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17023 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17024 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017025 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017026 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17027
17028 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17029 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17030 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17031 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17032 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17033 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017034 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017035 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17036 occurs.
17037
17038 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17039 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17040 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17041 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17042 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17043 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17044 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17045 cookies" below for more details.
17046
17047 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17048 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17049 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17050 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17051 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17052 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17053 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17054 and cookies" below for more details.
17055
17056 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17057 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17058 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17059 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17060 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17061 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17062 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17063 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17064
17065
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200170668.2.4. Custom log format
17067------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017068
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017069The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017070mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017071
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017072HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017073Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17074separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17075prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17076
17077Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17078variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017079("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017080
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017081If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017082as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017083less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17084the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17085
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017086Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017087In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017088in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017089
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017090Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17091'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17092https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17093such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17094
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017095Flags are :
17096 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017097 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017098 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17099 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017100
17101 Example:
17102
17103 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17104 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17105
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017106 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17107
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017108At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17109
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017110 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17111 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017112
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017113the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017114
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017115 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17116 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17117 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017118
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017119and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17120
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017121 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17122 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017123
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017124Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17125
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017126 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017127 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017128 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17129 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17130 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017131 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17132 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17133 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017134 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017135 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17136 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017137 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017138 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17139 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017140 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017141 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017142 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017143 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017144 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017145 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017146 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017147 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17148 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17149 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17150 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17151 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017152 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017153 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17154 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017155 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017156 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17157 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017158 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17159 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17160 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017161 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017162 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17163 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017164 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017165 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17166 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17167 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017168 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017169 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017170 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17171 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17172 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17173 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017174 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017175 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017176 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017177 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017178 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017179 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017180 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17181 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17182 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017183 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017184 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17185 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017186 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017187 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17188 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017189 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017190 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017191 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017192 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017193
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017194 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017195
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017196
171978.2.5. Error log format
17198-----------------------
17199
17200When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17201protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17202By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17203"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017204will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017205logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17206
17207The format looks like this :
17208
17209 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17210 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17211 Connection error during SSL handshake
17212
17213 Field Format Extract from the example above
17214 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17215 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17216 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17217 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17218 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17219
17220These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17221failures.
17222
17223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172248.3. Advanced logging options
17225-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017226
17227Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17228just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17229options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17230for more information about their usage.
17231
17232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172338.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17234------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017235
17236It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17237haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17238commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17239monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17240ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17241
17242 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17243 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17244 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17245 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17246
17247 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17248 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17249 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017250 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017251 such as other load-balancers.
17252
17253 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17254 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17255 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17256
17257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172588.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17259----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017260
17261The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17262what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17263or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017264"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017265just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17266log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17267after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17268is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17269with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17270with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17271
17272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172738.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17274------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017275
17276Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17277for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17278"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17279retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17280raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17281a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17282file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17283you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17284"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17285
17286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17288--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017289
17290Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17291multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17292them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17293"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17294logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17295error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17296and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17297too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17298useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17299alternative.
17300
17301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173028.4. Timing events
17303------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017304
17305Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17306reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17307the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17308frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017309mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17310addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17311
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017312Timings events in HTTP mode:
17313
17314 first request 2nd request
17315 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17316 t tr t tr ...
17317 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17318 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17319 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17320 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17321 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17322
17323Timings events in TCP mode:
17324
17325 TCP session
17326 |<----------------->|
17327 t t
17328 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17329 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17330 |<------ Tt ------->|
17331
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017332 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017333 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017334 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17335 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17336 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017337 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017338 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17339 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17340 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17341 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017342
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017343 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17344 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17345 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017346 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17347 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17348 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17349 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17350 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17351 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017352
17353 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17354 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17355 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17356 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17357 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17358 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17359 request typed by hand during a test.
17360
17361 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17362 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017363 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017364 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17365 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17366 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17367 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017368
17369 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17370 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17371 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17372 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17373 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17374
17375 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17376 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17377 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17378 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17379 connection never established.
17380
17381 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17382 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17383 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17384 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17385 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17386 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17387 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17388 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17389 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17390 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17391 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17392
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017393 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17394 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17395 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17396 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17397 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17398 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17399
17400 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17401
17402 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17403 "Ta" can never be negative.
17404
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017405 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17406 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017407 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17408 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017409 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017410
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017411 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017412
17413 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017414 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17415 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017416
17417These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17418protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17419that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017420due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17421"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17422that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017423
17424Most common cases :
17425
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017426 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17427 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17428 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17429 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17430 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17431 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17432 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17433 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17434 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17435 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17436 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017437 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017438
17439 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17440 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17441 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17442 of ms on remote networks.
17443
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017444 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17445 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17446 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017447
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017448 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17449 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17450 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17451 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17452 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17453 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17454 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17455 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17456 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017457
17458Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17459
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017460 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017461 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017462 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017463
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017464 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017465 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17466 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17467
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017468 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017469 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17470 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17471 flags.
17472
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017473 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17474 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017475 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17476 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17477 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17478 the client connection was maintained open.
17479
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017480 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017481 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017482 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017483 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17484
17485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174868.5. Session state at disconnection
17487-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017488
17489TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17490"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
174912-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17492each of which has a special meaning :
17493
17494 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17495 session to terminate :
17496
17497 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17498
17499 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17500 server explicitly refused it.
17501
17502 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17503 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17504 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17505 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017506 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017507
17508 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17509 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017510
17511 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17512 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17513 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17514 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17515 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17516
17517 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17518 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17519 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17520 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17521 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17522
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017523 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17524 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17525
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017526 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17527 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17528 backup connections when going up.
17529
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017530 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17531
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017532 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17533 send or receive data.
17534
17535 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17536 send or receive data.
17537
17538 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17539 with nothing left in the buffers.
17540
17541 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17542
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017543 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017544 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17545
17546 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17547 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17548 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17549 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17550 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17551
17552 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17553 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17554
17555 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17556 server (HTTP only).
17557
17558 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17559
17560 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17561 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17562 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17563
17564 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17565 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17566 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17567
17568 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17569
17570 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17571 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17572
17573 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17574 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17575 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17576
17577 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17578 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017579 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17580 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017581
17582 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17583 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17584 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17585 another server.
17586
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017587 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017588 server.
17589
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017590 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17591 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17592 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17593 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17594
17595 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17596 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17597 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17598 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17599
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017600 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17601 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17602 "use-server" rule).
17603
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017604 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17605
17606 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17607 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17608
17609 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17610
17611 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17612 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17613 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17614
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017615 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17616 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017617 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017618 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17619 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17620
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017621 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17622
17623 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17624 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17625
17626 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17627
17628 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17629
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017630The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17631was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017632helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17633starvation, attacks, etc...
17634
17635The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17636alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17637easier finding and understanding.
17638
17639 Flags Reason
17640
17641 -- Normal termination.
17642
17643 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17644 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17645 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17646 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17647
17648 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17649 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17650 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17651 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17652 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17653 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017654
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017655 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17656 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017657 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017658
17659 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17660 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17661 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17662
17663 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17664 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17665 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17666 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17667 the server takes too long to respond.
17668
17669 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17670 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17671 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17672 long a time to respond.
17673
17674 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17675 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17676 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17677 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017678 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17679 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017680
17681 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17682 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17683 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17684 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17685 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017686 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017687 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17688 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17689 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17690 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17691 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17692 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17693 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17694 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017695 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017696 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17697 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17698 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017699
17700 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17701 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017702 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17703 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17704 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17705 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017706
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017707 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17708 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017710 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017711 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17712 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017713 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017714 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17715 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17716
17717 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17718 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17719 503 or 504 here.
17720
17721 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17722 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17723 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17724 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17725 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17726
17727 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17728 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017729 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017730 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17731 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17732
17733 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17734 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17735 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17736 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17737 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17738 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17739 between haproxy and the server.
17740
17741 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17742 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17743 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17744 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17745 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17746 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17747 solution is to fix the application.
17748
17749 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17750 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17751 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17752 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17753 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17754 external attacks.
17755
17756 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17757 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017758 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017759 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17760 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17761
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017762 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17763 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17764 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017765 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017766 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017767
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017768 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17769 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17770 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17771 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017772 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17773 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17774 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17775 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17776 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017777
17778 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17779 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17780 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17781 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17782
17783 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17784 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17785 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17786 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17787
17788 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17789 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17790 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17791 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17792
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017793The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17794persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17795important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17796re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17797
17798 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17799
17800 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17801 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17802 set on a GET request.
17803
17804 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17805 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017806 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017807 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17808
17809 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17810 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17811 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17812
17813 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17814 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17815 already got a cookie.
17816
17817 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17818 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17819 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17820 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17821 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17822
17823 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17824 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17825 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17826
17827 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17828 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17829 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17830
17831 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17832 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17833
17834 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17835 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17836 then advertised in the response.
17837
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178398.6. Non-printable characters
17840-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017841
17842In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17843consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17844converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17845prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17846being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17847escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17848is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17849'}' when logging headers.
17850
17851Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17852issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17853containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17854
17855Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17856the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17857performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17858
17859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178608.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17861---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017862
17863Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17864achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017865section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017866cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17867the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17868the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017869locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017870not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17871user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17872a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17873wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17874
17875 Examples :
17876 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17877 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17878
17879 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17880 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17881
17882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178838.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17884---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017885
17886Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17887proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17888the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17889server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17890
17891Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17892response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017893section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017894
17895It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017896time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17897appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017898are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17899and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17900follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17901request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17902in the logs.
17903
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017904As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17905frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17906an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17907
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017908 Example :
17909 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17910 listen proxy-out
17911 mode http
17912 option httplog
17913 option logasap
17914 log global
17915 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17916
17917 # log the name of the virtual server
17918 capture request header Host len 20
17919
17920 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17921 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17922
17923 # log the beginning of the referrer
17924 capture request header Referer len 20
17925
17926 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17927 capture response header Server len 20
17928
17929 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17930 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17931
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017932 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017933 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17934
17935 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17936 capture response header Via len 20
17937
17938 # log the URL location during a redirection
17939 capture response header Location len 20
17940
17941 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17942 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17943 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17944 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17945 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17946
17947 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17948 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17949 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17950 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017951 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017952
17953 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17954 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17955 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17956 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17957 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017958 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017959
17960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179618.9. Examples of logs
17962---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017963
17964These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17965them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17966reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17967
17968 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17969 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17970 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17971
17972 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17973 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17974
17975 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17976 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17977 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17978
17979 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17980 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17981
17982 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17983 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17984 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17985
17986 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017987 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017988 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17989 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17990
17991 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17992 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17993 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17994
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017995 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17996 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17997 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17998 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17999 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18000 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018001
18002 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018003 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018004
18005 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18006 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18007 Nothing was sent to any server.
18008
18009 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18010 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18011
18012 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18013 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018014 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018015 send a 408 return code to the client.
18016
18017 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18018 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18019
18020 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18021 5 seconds ("c----").
18022
18023 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18024 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018025 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018026
18027 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018028 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018029 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18030 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18031 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18032 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18033 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018034
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018035
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200180369. Supported filters
18037--------------------
18038
18039Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18040accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18041unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18042
18043See also : "filter"
18044
180459.1. Trace
18046----------
18047
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018048filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018049
18050 Arguments:
18051 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18052 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18053
18054 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18055 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18056 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18057 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18058
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018059 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018060 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18061 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18062 amount of the parsed data.
18063
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018064 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018065
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018066This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18067callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18068information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18069filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18070
18071Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18072tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18073a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18074
18075
180769.2. HTTP compression
18077---------------------
18078
18079filter compression
18080
18081The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18082keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018083when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18084fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18085done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18086explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18087filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18088listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18089order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018090
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018091See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18092 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018093
18094
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200180959.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18096--------------------------------------------
18097
18098filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18099
18100 Arguments :
18101
18102 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18103 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18104 parsed.
18105
18106 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18107 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18108 part must be placed in its own scope.
18109
18110The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18111external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018112streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018113exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18114also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18115
18116SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18117the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18118
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018119For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018120"doc/SPOE.txt".
18121
18122Important note:
18123 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18124 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18125
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100181269.4. Cache
18127----------
18128
18129filter cache <name>
18130
18131 Arguments :
18132
18133 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18134
18135The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18136"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018137cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018138other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18139case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18140is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18141filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018142listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18143order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018144
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018145See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18146 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18147
18148
181499.5. Fcgi-app
18150-------------
18151
18152filter fcg-app <name>
18153
18154 Arguments :
18155
18156 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18157
18158The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18159request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18160reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18161used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18162implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18163used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18164fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18165used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18166order.
18167
18168See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18169 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18170
18171
1817210. FastCGI applications
18173-------------------------
18174
18175HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18176feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18177the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18178FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18179servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18180FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18181backend.
18182
18183HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18184application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18185connection.
18186
1818710.1. Setup
18188-----------
18189
1819010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18191--------------------------
18192
18193fcgi-app <name>
18194 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18195 document root must be defined.
18196
18197acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18198 Declare or complete an access list.
18199
18200 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18201 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18202 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18203 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18204 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18205
18206docroot <path>
18207 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18208 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18209 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18210
18211index <script-name>
18212 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18213 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18214 is an optional setting.
18215
18216 Example :
18217 index index.php
18218
18219log-stderr global
18220log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18221 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18222 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18223
18224 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18225 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18226
18227pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18228 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18229 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18230 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18231
18232 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18233 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18234 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18235 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18236
18237 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18238 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18239
18240path-info <regex>
18241 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18242 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18243 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18244 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18245 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18246
18247 Example :
18248 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18249
18250option get-values
18251no option get-values
18252 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18253
18254 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18255 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18256
18257 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18258 application will accept.
18259
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018260 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18261 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018262
18263 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18264 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18265 option is disabled.
18266
18267 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18268 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18269 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18270 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18271 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18272 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18273
18274option keep-conn
18275no option keep-conn
18276 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18277 sending a response.
18278
18279 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18280 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18281
18282option max-reqs <reqs>
18283 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18284 accept.
18285
18286 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18287 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18288 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18289 to 1.
18290
18291option mpxs-conns
18292no option mpxs-conns
18293 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18294
18295 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18296 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18297
18298set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18299 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18300 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18301 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18302 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18303
18304 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18305 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18306 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18307
18308 Example :
18309 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18310 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18311
18312 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18313
18314
1831510.1.2. Proxy section
18316---------------------
18317
18318use-fcgi-app <name>
18319 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18320
18321 Arguments :
18322 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18323
18324 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18325 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18326 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18327 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18328 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18329
18330 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18331 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18332 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18333 application are evaluated.
18334
18335
1833610.1.3. Example
18337---------------
18338
18339 frontend front-http
18340 mode http
18341 bind *:80
18342 bind *:
18343
18344 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18345 default_backend back-static
18346
18347 backend back-static
18348 mode http
18349 server www A.B.C.D:80
18350
18351 backend back-dynamic
18352 mode http
18353 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18354 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18355
18356 fcgi-app php-fpm
18357 log-stderr global
18358 option keep-conn
18359
18360 docroot /var/www/my-app
18361 index index.php
18362 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18363
18364
1836510.2. Default parameters
18366------------------------
18367
18368A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18369the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18370scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18371applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18372
18373 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18374 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18375 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18376 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18377 | | |
18378 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18379 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18380 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18381 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18382 | | application. |
18383 | | |
18384 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18385 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18386 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18387 | | |
18388 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18389 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18390 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18391 | | the application's configuration. |
18392 | | |
18393 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18394 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18395 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18396 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18397 | | |
18398 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18399 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18400 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18401 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18402 | | be defined. |
18403 | | |
18404 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18405 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18406 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18407 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18408 | | is not set too. |
18409 | | |
18410 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18411 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18412 | | set. |
18413 | | |
18414 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18415 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18416 | | the request. |
18417 | | |
18418 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18419 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18420 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18421 | | |
18422 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18423 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18424 | | script to process the request. |
18425 | | |
18426 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18427 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18428 | | |
18429 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18430 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18431 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18432 | | |
18433 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18434 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18435 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18436 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18437 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18438 | | |
18439 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18440 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18441 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18442 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18443 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18444 | | side. |
18445 | | |
18446 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18447 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18448 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18449 | | connected to. |
18450 | | |
18451 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18452 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18453 | | |
18454 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18455 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18456 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18457 | | |
18458 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18459
18460
1846110.3. Limitations
18462------------------
18463
18464The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18465way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18466during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18467establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18468application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18469or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18470message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18471these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18472and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18473
18474Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18475request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18476requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18477
18478About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18479into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18480fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18481"http-request" ones.
18482
18483Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18484FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18485processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18486must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18487here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018489/*
18490 * Local variables:
18491 * fill-column: 79
18492 * End:
18493 */